NUMONYX N25Q128A43ESFH0G

N25Q128
128-Mbit 3 V, multiple I/O, 4-Kbyte subsector erase on boot sectors,
XiP enabled, serial flash memory with 108 MHz SPI bus interface
Features
„ SPI-compatible serial bus interface
„ 108 MHz (maximum) clock frequency
„ 2.7 V to 3.6 V single supply voltage
VDFPN8 (F8)
8 × 6 mm (MLP8)
„ Supports legacy SPI protocol and new Quad
I/O or Dual I/O SPI protocol
SO16 (SF)
300 mils width
„ Quad/Dual I/O instructions resulting in an
equivalent clock frequency up to 432 MHz:
„ XIP mode for all three protocols
– Configurable via volatile or non-volatile
registers (enabling the memory to work in
XiP mode directly after power on)
TBGA24 (12)
6 x 8 mm
„ Program/Erase suspend instructions
„ Continuous read of entire memory via single
instruction:
– Fast Read
– Quad or Dual Output Fast Read
– Quad or Dual I/O Fast Read
– Additional smart protections available upon
customer request
„ Flexible to fit application:
– Configurable number of dummy cycles
– Output buffer configurable
– Fast POR instruction to speed up power on
phase
– Reset function available upon customer
request
„ 64-byte user-lockable, one-time programmable
(OTP) area
„ Erase capability
– Subsector (4-Kbyte) granularity in the 8
boot sectors (bottom or top parts).
– Sector (64-Kbyte) granularity
„ Electronic signature
– JEDEC standard two-byte signature
(BA18h)
– Additional 2 Extended Device ID (EDID)
bytes to identify device factory options
– Unique ID code (UID) with 14 bytes readonly, available upon customer request
„ More than 100,000 program/erase cycles per
sector
„ More than 20 years data retention
„ Packages
– RoHS compliant
„ Write protections
– Software write protection applicable to
every 64-Kbyte sector (volatile lock bit)
– Hardware write protection: protected area
size defined by five non-volatile bits (BP0,
BP1, BP2, BP3 and TB bit)
February 2010
Rev 1.0
1/180
www.numonyx.com
1
Contents
M25Q128 - 3 V
Contents
1
Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
2
Signal descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.1
Serial data output (DQ1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.2
Serial data input (DQ0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.3
Serial Clock (C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.4
Chip Select (S) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.5
Hold (HOLD) or Reset (Reset) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
2.6
Write protect/enhanced program supply voltage (W/VPP), DQ2 . . . . . . . 18
2.7
VCC supply voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
2.8
VSS ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
3
SPI Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
4
SPI Protocols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
5
4.1
Extended SPI protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.2
Dual I/O SPI (DIO-SPI) protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.3
Quad SPI (QIO-SPI) protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Operating features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1
5.2
Extended SPI Protocol Operating features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1.1
Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1.2
Page programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1.3
Dual input fast program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1.4
Dual Input Extended Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.1.5
Quad Input Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
5.1.6
Quad Input Extended Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
5.1.7
Subsector erase, sector erase and bulk erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
5.1.8
Polling during a write, program or erase cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
5.1.9
Active power and standby power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
5.1.10
Hold (or Reset) condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Dual SPI (DIO-SPI) Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
5.2.1
2/180
Multiple Read Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
M25Q128 - 3 V
5.3
6
Contents
5.2.2
Dual Command Fast reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
5.2.3
Page programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
5.2.4
Subsector Erase, Sector Erase and Bulk Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
5.2.5
Polling during a Write, Program or Erase cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
5.2.6
Read and Modify registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
5.2.7
Active Power and Standby Power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
5.2.8
HOLD (or Reset) condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Quad SPI (QIO-SPI)Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
5.3.1
Multiple Read Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
5.3.2
Quad Command Fast reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
5.3.3
QUAD Command Page programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
5.3.4
Subsector Erase, Sector Erase and Bulk Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
5.3.5
Polling during a Write, Program or Erase cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
5.3.6
Read and Modify registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
5.3.7
Active Power and Standby Power modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
5.3.8
HOLD (or Reset) condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
5.3.9
VPP pin Enhanced Supply Voltage feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
Legacy SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
6.1.1
WIP bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
6.1.2
WEL bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
6.1.3
BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0 bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
6.1.4
TB bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
6.1.5
SRWD bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Non Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
6.2.1
Dummy clock cycle NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 15 to 12) . . 37
6.2.2
XIP NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 11 to 9) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
6.2.3
Output Driver Strength NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 8 to 6) . . 38
6.2.4
Fast POR NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 5) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
6.2.5
Hold (Reset) disable NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
6.2.6
Quad Input NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
6.2.7
Dual Input NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
6.3.1
Dummy clock cycle: VCR bits 7 to 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
6.3.2
XIP Volatile Configuration bits (VCR bit 3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
3/180
Contents
M25Q128 - 3 V
6.5
7
6.4.1
Quad Input Command VECR<7> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
6.4.2
Dual Input Command VECR<6> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
6.4.3
Reset/Hold disable VECR<4> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
6.4.4
Accelerator pin enable: QIO-SPI protocol / QIFP/QIEFP VECR<3> . . . 43
6.4.5
Output Driver Strength VECR<2:0> . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
6.5.1
P/E Controller Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
6.5.2
Erase Suspend Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
6.5.3
Erase Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
6.5.4
Program Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
6.5.5
VPP Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
6.5.6
Program Suspend Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
6.5.7
Protection Status bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Protection modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
7.1
SPI Protocol-related protections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
7.2
Specific hardware and software protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
8
Memory organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
9
Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
9.1
4/180
Extended SPI Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
9.1.1
Read Identification (RDID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
9.1.2
Read Data Bytes (READ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
9.1.3
Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
9.1.4
Dual Output Fast Read (DOFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
9.1.5
Dual I/O Fast Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
9.1.6
Quad Output Fast Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
9.1.7
Quad I/O Fast Read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
9.1.8
Read OTP (ROTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
9.1.9
Write Enable (WREN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
9.1.10
Write Disable (WRDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
9.1.11
Page Program (PP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
9.1.12
Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
9.1.13
Dual Input Extended Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
9.1.14
Quad Input Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
9.1.15
Quad Input Extended Fast Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
M25Q128 - 3 V
9.2
Contents
9.1.16
Program OTP instruction (POTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
9.1.17
Subsector Erase (SSE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
9.1.18
Sector Erase (SE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
9.1.19
Bulk Erase (BE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
9.1.20
Program/Erase Suspend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
9.1.21
Program/Erase Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
9.1.22
Read Status Register (RDSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
9.1.23
Write status register (WRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
9.1.24
Read Lock Register (RDLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
9.1.25
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
9.1.26
Read Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
9.1.27
Clear Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
9.1.28
Read NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
9.1.29
Write NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
9.1.30
Read Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
9.1.31
Write Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
9.1.32
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
9.1.33
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
DIO-SPI Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
9.2.1
Multiple I/O Read Identification protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
9.2.2
Dual Command Fast Read (DCFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
9.2.3
Read OTP (ROTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
9.2.4
Write Enable (WREN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
9.2.5
Write Disable (WRDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
9.2.6
Dual Command Page Program (DCPP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
9.2.7
Program OTP instruction (POTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
9.2.8
Subsector Erase (SSE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
9.2.9
Sector Erase (SE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
9.2.10
Bulk Erase (BE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
9.2.11
Program/Erase Suspend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
9.2.12
Program/Erase Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
9.2.13
Read Status Register (RDSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
9.2.14
Write status register (WRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
9.2.15
Read Lock Register (RDLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
9.2.16
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
9.2.17
Read Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
9.2.18
Clear Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
5/180
Contents
M25Q128 - 3 V
9.3
10
6/180
9.2.19
Read NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
9.2.20
Write NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
9.2.21
Read Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
9.2.22
Write Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
9.2.23
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
9.2.24
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
QIO-SPI Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
9.3.1
Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
9.3.2
Quad Command Fast Read (QCFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
9.3.3
Read OTP (ROTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
9.3.4
Write Enable (WREN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
9.3.5
Write Disable (WRDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
9.3.6
Quad Command Page Program (QCPP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
9.3.7
Program OTP instruction (POTP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
9.3.8
Subsector Erase (SSE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
9.3.9
Sector Erase (SE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
9.3.10
Bulk Erase (BE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
9.3.11
Program/Erase Suspend . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
9.3.12
Program/Erase Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
9.3.13
Read Status Register (RDSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.3.14
Write status register (WRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
9.3.15
Read Lock Register (RDLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
9.3.16
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
9.3.17
Read Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
9.3.18
Clear Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
9.3.19
Read NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
9.3.20
Write NV Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
9.3.21
Read Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
9.3.22
Write Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
9.3.23
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
9.3.24
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
XIP Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
10.1
Enter XIP mode by setting the Non Volatile Configuration Register . . . . 157
10.2
Enter XIP mode by setting the Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . 159
10.3
XIP mode hold and exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
10.4
XIP Memory reset after a controller reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
M25Q128 - 3 V
11
Contents
Power-up and power-down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
11.1
Fast POR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
11.2
Rescue sequence in case of power loss during WRNVCR . . . . . . . . . . 164
12
Initial delivery state . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
13
Maximum rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
14
DC and AC parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
15
Package mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
16
Ordering information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
17
Revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
7/180
List of tables
M25Q128 - 3 V
List of tables
Table 1.
Table 2.
Table 3.
Table 4.
Table 5.
Table 6.
Table 7.
Table 8.
Table 9.
Table 10.
Table 11.
Table 12.
Table 13.
Table 14.
Table 15.
Table 16.
Table 17.
Table 18.
Table 19.
Table 20.
Table 21.
Table 22.
Table 23.
Table 24.
Table 25.
Table 26.
Table 27.
Table 28.
Table 29.
Table 30.
Table 31.
Table 32.
Table 33.
Table 34.
Table 35.
Table 36.
Table 37.
Table 38.
Table 39.
8/180
Signal names . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Status register format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Non-Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Maximum allowed frequency (MHz). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Volatile Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Flag Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Software protection truth table (Sectors 0 to 255, 64 Kbyte granularity) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Protected area sizes (TB bit = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Protected area sizes (TB bit = 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Memory organization (uniform) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Memory organization (bottom) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Memory organization (top) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Instruction set: extended SPI protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Read Identification data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Extended Device ID table (first byte) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Suspend Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Operations Allowed / Disallowed During Device States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Protection modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Lock Register out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Lock Register in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Instruction set: DIO-SPI protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Instruction set: QIO-SPI protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
NVCR XIP bits setting example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
VCR XIP bits setting example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Power-up timing and VWI threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Absolute maximum ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
AC measurement conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Capacitance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Reset Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
VDFPN8 (MLP8) 8-lead very thin dual flat package no lead,
8 × 6 mm, package mechanical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
SO16 wide - 16-lead plastic small outline, 300 mils body width, mechanical data . . . . . . 174
TBGA 6x8 mm 24-ball package dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Ordering information scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Valid Order Information Line Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Document revision history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
M25Q128 - 3 V
List of figures
List of figures
Figure 1.
Figure 2.
Figure 3.
Figure 4.
Figure 5.
Figure 6.
Figure 7.
Figure 8.
Figure 9.
Figure 10.
Figure 11.
Figure 12.
Figure 13.
Figure 14.
Figure 15.
Figure 16.
Figure 17.
Figure 18.
Figure 19.
Figure 20.
Figure 21.
Figure 22.
Figure 23.
Figure 24.
Figure 25.
Figure 26.
Figure 27.
Figure 28.
Figure 29.
Figure 30.
Figure 31.
Figure 32.
Figure 33.
Figure 34.
Figure 35.
Figure 36.
Figure 37.
Figure 38.
Figure 39.
Figure 40.
Figure 41.
Figure 42.
Figure 43.
Figure 44.
Figure 45.
Figure 46.
Figure 47.
Figure 48.
Logic diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
VDFPN8 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
SO16 connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
BGA connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Bus master and memory devices on the SPI bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Extended SPI protocol example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Hold condition activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Non Volatile and Volatile configuration Register Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Read identification instruction and data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Read Data Bytes instruction and data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed instruction and data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Dual Output Fast Read instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Dual I/O Fast Read instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Quad Input/Output Fast Read instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Quad Input/ Output Fast Read instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Write Enable instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Write Disable instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Page Program instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Dual Input Fast Program instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Dual Input Extended Fast Program instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Quad Input Fast Program instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Quad Input Extended Fast Program instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Program OTP instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
How to permanently lock the OTP bytes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Subsector Erase instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Sector Erase instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Bulk Erase instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Read Status Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Write Status Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Write to Lock Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Multiple I/O Read Identification instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . 114
Dual Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Write Enable instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Write Disable instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, 02h . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, A2h . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
9/180
List of figures
Figure 49.
Figure 50.
Figure 51.
Figure 52.
Figure 53.
Figure 54.
Figure 55.
Figure 56.
Figure 57.
Figure 58.
Figure 59.
Figure 60.
Figure 61.
Figure 62.
Figure 63.
Figure 64.
Figure 65.
Figure 66.
Figure 67.
Figure 68.
Figure 69.
Figure 70.
Figure 71.
Figure 72.
Figure 73.
Figure 74.
Figure 75.
Figure 76.
Figure 77.
Figure 78.
Figure 79.
Figure 80.
Figure 81.
Figure 82.
Figure 83.
Figure 84.
Figure 85.
Figure 86.
Figure 87.
Figure 88.
Figure 89.
Figure 90.
Figure 91.
Figure 92.
Figure 93.
Figure 94.
Figure 95.
Figure 96.
Figure 97.
Figure 98.
Figure 99.
Figure 100.
10/180
M25Q128 - 3 V
Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, D2h . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Program OTP instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Subsector Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Sector Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Bulk Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Program/Erase Suspend instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Program/Erase Resume instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Read Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Write Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Write to Lock Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . 128
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI . . . . . . . 129
Multiple I/O Read Identification instruction and data-out sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . 132
Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, 0Bh . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, 6Bh . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, EBh . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Write Enable instruction sequence QIO-SPI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Write Disable instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 02h. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 12h. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 32h. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Program OTP instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Subsector Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Sector Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Bulk Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Program/Erase Suspend instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Program/Erase Resume instruction sequence QIO-SPI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Read Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Write Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Write to Lock Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . 154
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI . . . . . . . 155
N25Q128 Read functionality Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
XIP mode directly after power on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
XiP: enter by VCR 2/2 (QIOFR in normal SPI protocol example) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Power-up timing, Fast POR selected . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Power-up timing, Fast POR not selected . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
M25Q128 - 3 V
List of figures
Figure 101.
Figure 102.
Figure 103.
Figure 104.
Figure 105.
Figure 106.
Figure 107.
Figure 108.
AC measurement I/O waveform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Reset AC waveforms while a program or erase cycle is in progress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Serial input timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Write protect setup and hold timing during WRSR when SRWD=1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Hold timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Output timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
VPPH timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
VDFPN8 (MLP8) 8-lead very thin dual flat package no lead,
8 × 6 mm, package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Figure 109. SO16 wide - 16-lead plastic small outline, 300 mils body width, package outline . . . . . . 174
Figure 110. TBGA - 6 x 8 mm, 24-ball, mechanical package outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
11/180
Description
1
N25Q128 - 3 V
Description
The N25Q128 is a 128 Mbit (16Mb x 8) serial Flash memory, with advanced write protection
mechanisms. It is accessed by a high speed SPI-compatible bus and features the possibility
to work in XIP (“eXecution in Place”) mode.
The N25Q128 supports innovative, high-performance quad/dual I/O instructions, these new
instructions allow to double or quadruple the transfer bandwidth for read and program
operations.
Furthermore the memory can be operated with 3 different protocols:
„
Standard SPI (Extended SPI protocol)
„
Dual I/O SPI
„
Quad I/O SPI
The Standard SPI protocol is enriched by the new quad and dual instructions (Extended SPI
protocol). For Dual I/O SPI (DIO-SPI) all the instructions codes, the addresses and the data
are always transmitted across two data lines. For Quad I/O SPI (QIO-SPI) the instructions
codes, the addresses and the data are always transmitted across four data lines thus
enabling a tremendous improvement in both random access time and data throughput.
The memory can work in “XIP mode”, that means the device only requires the addresses
and not the instructions to output the data. This mode dramatically reduces random access
time thus enabling many applications requiring fast code execution without shadowing the
memory content on a RAM.
The XIP mode can be used with QIO-SPI, DIO-SPI, or Extended SPI protocol, and can be
entered and exited using different dedicated instructions to allow maximum flexibility: for
applications required to enter in XIP mode right after power up of the device, this can be set
as default mode by using dedicated Non Volatile Register (NVR) bits.
It is also possible to reduce the power on sequence time with the Fast POR (Power on
Reset) feature, enabling a reduction of the latency time before the first read instruction can
be performed. Another feature is the ability to pause and resume program and erase cycles
by using dedicated Program/Erase Suspend and Resume instructions.
The N25Q128 memory offers the following additional Features to be configured by using the
Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR) for default /Non-Volatile settings or by using the
Volatile and Volatile Enhanced Configuration Registers for Volatile settings:
„
the number of dummy cycles for fast read instructions (single, dual and, quad I/O)
according to the operating frequency
„
the output buffer impedance
„
the type of SPI protocol (extended SPI, DIO-SPI or QIO-SPI)
„
the required XIP mode
„
Fast or standard POR sequence
„
the Hold (Reset) functionality enabling/disabling
The memory is organized as 248 (64-Kbyte) main sectors, in products with Bottom or Top
architecture there are 8 64-Kbyte boot sectors, and each boot sector is further divided into
16 4-Kbyte subsectors (128 subsectors in total). The boot sectors can be erased a 4-Kbyte
subsector at a time or as a 64-Kbyte sector at a time. The entire memory can be also erased
at a time or by sector.
12/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Description
The memory can be write protected by software using a mix of volatile and non-volatile
protection features, depending on the application needs. The protection granularity is of 64Kbyte (sector granularity) for volatile protections.
The N25Q128 has 64 one-time-programmable bytes (OTP bytes) that can be read and
programmed using two dedicated instructions, Read OTP (ROTP) and Program OTP
(POTP), respectively. These 64 bytes can be permanently locked by a particular Program
OTP (POTP) sequence. Once they have been locked, they become read-only and this state
cannot be reversed.
Many different N25Q128 configurations are available, please refer to the ordering scheme
page for the possibilities. Additional features are available as security options (The Security
features are described in a dedicated Application Note). Please contact your nearest
Numonyx Sales office for more information.
Figure 1.
Logic diagram
VCC
DQ0
DQ1
C
S
W/VPP/DQ2
HOLD/DQ3
VSS
Logic_Diagram_x25x
Note:
Reset functionality is available in devices with a dedicated part number. See Section 16:
Ordering information.
Table 1.
Signal names
Signal
Description
I/O
C
Serial Clock
Input
DQ0
Serial Data input
I/O(1)
DQ1
Serial Data output
I/O(2)
S
Chip Select
Input
W/VPP/DQ2
Write Protect/Enhanced Program supply voltage/additional data I/O
I/O(3)
HOLD/DQ3(4)
Hold (Reset function available upon customer request)/additional data I/O
I/O(3)
VCC
Supply voltage
–
VSS
Ground
–
1. Provides dual and quad I/O for Extended SPI protocol instructions, dual I/O for Dual I/O SPI protocol instructions, and
quad I/O for Quad I/O SPI protocol instructions.
2. Provides dual and quad instruction input for Extended SPI protocol, dual instruction input for Dual I/O SPI protocol, and
quad instruction input for Quad I/O SPI protocol.
3. Provides quad I/O for Extended SPI protocol instructions, and quad I/O for Quad I/O SPI protocol instructions.
4. Reset functionality available with a dedicated part number. See Section 16: Ordering information.
13/180
Description
Note:
N25Q128 - 3 V
There is an exposed central pad on the underside of the VDFPN8 package. This is pulled,
internally, to VSS, and must not be connected to any other voltage or signal line on the PCB.
Figure 2.
VDFPN8 connections
S
DQ1
W/VPP/DQ2
VSS
8
7
6
5
1
2
3
4
VCC
HOLD/DQ3
C
DQ0
AI13720c
1. Reset functionality available in devices with a dedicated part number. See Section 16: Ordering
information.
Figure 3.
SO16 connections
HOLD/DQ3
VCC
DU
DU
DU
DU
S
DQ1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
C
DQ0
DU
DU
DU
DU
VSS
W/VPP/DQ2
AI13721c
1. DU = don’t use.
2. See Package mechanical section for package dimensions, and how to identify pin-1.
3. Reset functionality available in devices with a dedicated part number. See Section 16: Ordering
information.
14/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 4.
Description
BGA connections
1
A
B
NC
C
NC
D
NC
E
NC
2
3
4
5
NC
NC
NC
NC
C
VSS
VCC
NC
S
W/VPP/DQ2
NC
DQ1
NC
NC
DQ0 HOLD/DQ3
NC
NC
NC
NC
1. NC = No Connect.
2. See Figure 110.: TBGA - 6 x 8 mm, 24-ball, mechanical package outline.
15/180
Signal descriptions
2
Signal descriptions
2.1
Serial data output (DQ1)
N25Q128 - 3 V
This output signal is used to transfer data serially out of the device. Data are shifted out on
the falling edge of Serial Clock (C). When used as an Input, It is latched on the rising edge
of the Serial Clock (C).
In the Extended SPI protocol, during the Quad and Dual Input Fast Program (QIFP, DIFP)
instructions and during the Quad and Dual Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP, DIEFP)
instructions, pin DQ1 is used also as an input.
In the Dual I/O SPI protocol (DIO-SPI) the DQ1 pin always acts as an input/output.
In the Quad I/O SPI protocol (QIO-SPI) the DQ1 pin always acts as an input/output, with the
exception of the Program or Erase cycle performed with the Enhanced Program Supply
Voltage (VPP). In this case the device temporarily goes in Extended SPI protocol. The
protocol then becomes QIO-SPI as soon as the VPP pin voltage goes low.
2.2
Serial data input (DQ0)
This input signal is used to transfer data serially into the device. It receives instructions,
addresses, and the data to be programmed. Values are latched on the rising edge of Serial
Clock (C). Data are shifted out on the falling edge of the Serial Clock (C).
In the Extended SPI protocol, during the Quad and Dual Output Fast Read (QOFR, DOFR)
and the Quad and Dual Input/Output Fast Read (QIOFR, DIOFR) instructions, pin DQ0 is
also used as an input/output.
In the DIO-SPI protocol the DQ0 pin always acts as an input/output.
In the QIO-SPI protocol, the DQ0 pin always acts as an input/output, with the exception of
the Program or Erase cycle performed with the VPP. In this case the device temporarily
goes in Extended SPI protocol. Then, the protocol returns to QIO-SPI as soon as the VPP
pin voltage goes low.
2.3
Serial Clock (C)
This input signal provides the timing for the serial interface. Instructions, addresses, or data
present at serial data input (DQ0) are latched on the rising edge of Serial Clock (C). Data
are shifted out on the falling edge of the Serial Clock (C).
2.4
Chip Select (S)
When this input signal is high, the device is deselected and serial data output (DQ1) is at
high impedance. Unless an internal program, erase or write status register cycle is in
progress, the device will be in the standby power mode (this is not the deep power-down
mode). Driving Chip Select (S) low enables the device, placing it in the active power mode.
After power-up, a falling edge on Chip Select (S) is required prior to the start of any
instruction.
16/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
2.5
Signal descriptions
Hold (HOLD) or Reset (Reset)
The Hold (HOLD) signal is used to pause any serial communications with the device without
deselecting the device.
Reset functionality is present instead of Hold in devices with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
During Hold condition, the Serial Data output (DQ1) is in high impedance, and Serial Data
input (DQ0) and Serial Clock (C) are Don't Care.
To start the Hold condition, the device must be selected, with Chip Select (S) driven Low.
For devices featuring Reset instead of Hold functionality, the Reset (Reset) input provides a
hardware reset for the memory.
When Reset (Reset) is driven High, the memory is in the normal operating mode. When
Reset (Reset) is driven Low, the memory will enter the Reset mode. In this mode, the output
is high impedance.
Driving Reset (Reset) Low while an internal operation is in progress will affect this operation
(write, program or erase cycle) and data may be lost.
In the Extended SPI protocol, during the QOFR, QIOFR, QIFP and the Quad Extended Fast
Program (QIEFP) instructions, the Hold (Reset) / DQ3 is used as an input/output (DQ3
functionality).
In QIO-SPI, the Hold (Reset) / DQ3 pin acts as an I/O (DQ3 functionality), and the HOLD
(Reset) functionality disabled when the device is selected. When the device is deselected (S
signal is high), in parts with Reset functionality, it is possible to reset the device unless this
functionality is not disabled by mean of dedicated registers bits.
The HOLD (Reset) functionality can be disabled using bit 3 of the NVCR or bit 4 of the VECR.
17/180
Signal descriptions
2.6
N25Q128 - 3 V
Write protect/enhanced program supply voltage (W/VPP),
DQ2
W/VPP/DQ2 can be used as:
„
A protection control input.
„
A power supply pin.
„
I/O in Extended SPI protocol quad instructions and in QIO-SPI protocol instructions.
When the device is operated in Extended SPI protocol with single or dual instructions, the
two functions W or VPP are selected by the voltage range applied to the pin. If the W/VPP
input is kept in a low voltage range (0 V to VCC) the pin is seen as a control input. This input
signal is used to freeze the size of the area of memory that is protected against program or
erase instructions (as specified by the values in the BP[0:3] bits of the Status Register. (See
Table 2.: Status register format).
If VPP is in the range of VPPH, it acts as an additional power supply during the Program or
Erase cycles (See Table 28.: Operating conditions). In this case VPP must be stable until
the Program or Erase algorithm is completed.
During the Extended SPI protocol, the QOFR and QIOFR instructions, and the QIO-SPI
protocol instructions, the pin W/VPP/DQ2 is used as an input/output (DQ2 functionality).
Using the Extended SPI protocol the QIFP, QIEFP and the QIO-SPI Program/Erase
instructions, it is still possible to use the VPP additional power supply to speed up internal
operations. However, to enable this possibility it is necessary to set bit 3 of the Volatile
Enhanced Configuration Register to 0.
In this case the W/VPP/DQ2 pin is used as an I/O pin until the end of the instruction
sequence. After the last input data is shifted in, the application should apply VPP voltage to
W/VPP/DQ2 within 200 ms to speed up the internal operations. If the VPP voltage is not
applied within 200 ms the Program/Erase operations start with standard speed.
The default value of the VECR bit 3 is 1, and the VPP functionality for Quad I/O modify
instruction is disabled.
2.7
VCC supply voltage
VCC is the supply voltage.
2.8
VSS ground
VSS is the reference for the VCC supply voltage.
18/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
3
SPI Modes
SPI Modes
These devices can be driven by a micro controller with its SPI peripheral running in either of
the two following modes:
CPOL=0, CPHA=0
CPOL=1, CPHA=1
For these two modes, input data is latched in on the rising edge of Serial Clock (C), and
output data is available from the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The difference between the two modes, as shown in Figure 5, is the clock polarity when the
bus master is in standby mode and not transferring data:
C remains at 0 for (CPOL=0, CPHA=0)
C remains at 1 for (CPOL=1, CPHA=1)
Figure 5.
Bus master and memory devices on the SPI bus
VSS
VCC
R
SDO
SPI interface with
(CPOL, CPHA) =
(0, 0) or (1, 1)
SDI
SCK
VCC
C
SPI Bus Master
R
CS3
VCC
C
DQ1DQ0
VSS
SPI memory
device
R
VCC
C
DQ1 DQ0
VSS
DQ1DQ0
SPI memory
device
R
SPI memory
device
VSS
CS2 CS1
S
W
HOLD
S
W
HOLD
S
W
HOLD
AI13725b
Shown here is an example of three devices working in Extended SPI protocol for simplicity
connected to an MCU, on an SPI bus. Only one device is selected at a time, so only one
device drives the serial data output (DQ1) line at a time; the other devices are high
impedance. Resistors R ensures that the N25Q128 is not selected if the bus master leaves
the S line in the high impedance state. As the bus master may enter a state where all
inputs/outputs are in high impedance at the same time (for example, when the bus master is
reset), the clock line (C) must be connected to an external pull-down resistor so that, when
all inputs/outputs become high impedance, the S line is pulled High while the C line is pulled
Low. This ensures that S and C do not become High at the same time, and so that the tSHCH
requirement is met. The typical value of R is 100 kΩ, assuming that the time constant R*Cp
19/180
SPI Modes
N25Q128 - 3 V
(Cp = parasitic capacitance of the bus line) is shorter than the time during which the bus
master leaves the SPI bus in high impedance.
Example: Cp = 50 pF, that is R*Cp = 5 µs <=> the application must ensure that the bus
master never leaves the SPI bus in the high impedance state for a time period shorter than
5 µs. The Write Protect (W) and Hold (HOLD) signals should be driven, High or Low as
appropriate.
Figure 6.
Extended SPI protocol example
CPOL CPHA
0
0
C
1
1
C
DQ0
DQ1
MSB
MSB
AI13730
20/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
4
SPI Protocols
SPI Protocols
The N25Q128 memory can work with 3 different Serial protocols:
„
Extended SPI protocol.
„
Dual I/O SPI (DIO-SPI) protocol.
„
Quad I/O SPI (QIO-SPI) protocol.
It is possible to choose among the three protocols by means of user volatile or non-volatile
configuration bits.It's not possible to mix Extended SPI, DIO-SPI, and QIO-SPI protocols.
The device can operate in XIP mode in all 3 protocols.
4.1
Extended SPI protocol
This is an extension of the standard (legacy) SPI protocol. Instructions are transmitted on a
single data line (DQ0), while addresses and data are transmitted by one, two or four data
lines (DQ0, DQ1, W/VPP(DQ2) and HOLD / (DQ3) according to the instruction.
When used in the Extended SPI protocol, these devices can be driven by a micro controller
in either of the two following modes:
„
CPOL=0, CPHA=0
„
CPOL=1, CPHA=1
Please refer to the SPI modes for a detailed description of these two modes
4.2
Dual I/O SPI (DIO-SPI) protocol
Dual I/O SPI (DIO-SPI) protocol: instructions, addresses and I/O data are always
transmitted on two data lines (DQ0 and DQ1).
Also when in DIO-SPI mode, the device can be driven by a micro controller in either of the
two following modes:
„
CPOL= 0, CPHA= 0
„
CPOL= 1, CPHA= 1
Please refer to the SPI modes for a detailed description of these two modes.
Note:
Extended SPI protocol Dual I/O instructions allow only address and data to be transmitted
over two data lines. However, DIO-SPI allows instructions, addresses, and data to be
transmitted on two data lines.
This mode can be set using two ways
„
Volatile: by setting bit 6 of the VECR to 0. The device enters DIO-SPI protocol
immediately after the Write Enhanced Volatile Configuration Register sequence
completes. The device returns to the default working mode (defined by NVCR) on
power on.
„
Default/ Non-Volatile: This is default mode on power-up. By setting bit 2 of the NVCR
to 0. The device enters DIO-SPI protocol on the subsequent power-on. After all
subsequent power-on sequences, the device still starts in DIO-SPI protocol unless bit 2
of NVCR is set to 1 (default value, corresponding to Extended SPI protocol) or bit 3 of
NVCR is set to 0 (corresponding to QIO-SPI protocol).
21/180
SPI Protocols
4.3
N25Q128 - 3 V
Quad SPI (QIO-SPI) protocol
Quad SPI (QIO-SPI) protocol: instructions, addresses, and I/O data are always transmitted
on four data lines DQ0, DQ1, W/VPP(DQ2), and HOLD / (DQ3).
The exception is the Program/Erase cycle performed with the VPP, in which case the device
temporarily goes to Extended SPI protocol. Going temporarily into Extended SPI protocol
allows the application either to:
Note:
„
check the polling bits: WIP bit in the Status Register or Program/Erase Controller bit in
the Flag Status Register
„
perform Program/Erase suspend functions.
As soon as the VPP pin voltage goes low, the protocol returns to the QIO-SPI protocol.
In QIO-SPI protocol the W and HOLD/ (RESET) functionality is disabled when the device is
selected (S signal low).
When used in the QIO-SPI mode, these devices can be driven by a micro controller in either
of the two following modes:
„
CPOL=0, CPHA=0
„
CPOL=1, CPHA=1
Please refer to the SPI modes for a detailed description of the 2 modes.
Note:
In the Extended SPI protocol only Address and data are allowed to be transmitted on 4 data
lines, However in QIO-SPI protocol, the address, data and instructions are transmitted
across 4 data lines.
This working mode is set in either bit 7 of the Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
(VECR) or in bit 3 of the Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR).
This mode can be set using two ways
22/180
„
Volatile: by setting bit 7 of the VECR to 0, the device enters QIO-SPI protocol
immediately after the Write Enhanced Volatile Configuration Register sequence
completes. The device returns to the default working protocol (defined by the NVCR)
on the next power on.
„
Default/ Non- Volatile: This is default protocol on power up. By setting bit 3 of the
NVCR to 0, the device enters QIO-SPI protocol on the subsequent power-on. After all
subsequent power-on sequences, the device still starts in QIO-SPI protocol unless bit 3
of the NVCR is set to 1 (default value, corresponding to Extended SPI mode).
N25Q128 - 3 V
5
Operating features
5.1
Extended SPI Protocol Operating features
5.1.1
Read Operations
Operating features
To read the memory content in Extended SPI protocol different instructions are available:
READ, Fast Read, Dual Output Fast Read, Dual Input Output Fast Read, Quad Output Fast
Read and Quad Input Output Fast read, allowing the application to choose an instruction to
send addresses and receive data by one, two or four data lines.
Note:
In the Extended SPI protocol the instruction code is always sent on one data line (DQ0): to
use two or four data lines the user must use either the DIO-SPI or the QIO-SPI protocol
respectively.
For fast read instructions the number of dummy clock cycles is configurable by using VCR
bits [7:4] or NVCR bits [15:12].
After a successful reading instruction a reduced tSHSL equal to 20 ns is allowed to further
improve random access time (in all the other cases tSHSL should be at least 50 ns). See
Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
5.1.2
Page programming
To program one data byte, two instructions are required: write enable (WREN), which is one
byte, and a page program (PP) sequence, which consists of four bytes plus data. This is
followed by the internal program cycle (of duration tPP).
To spread this overhead, the page program (PP) instruction allows up to 256 bytes to be
programmed at a time (changing bits from ‘1’ to ‘0’), provided that they lie in consecutive
addresses on the same page of memory.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the page program (PP) instruction to
program all consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence versus using several page
program (PP) sequences with each containing only a few bytes (see Section 5.2.3: Page
programming and Table 32: AC Characteristics).
5.1.3
Dual input fast program
The dual input fast program (DIFP) instruction makes it possible to program up to 256 bytes
using two input pins at the same time (by changing bits from ‘1’ to ‘0’).
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the DIFP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather using several DIFP sequences each
containing only a few bytes (see Section 9.1.12: Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP)).
5.1.4
Dual Input Extended Fast Program
The Dual Input Extended Fast Program (DIEFP) instruction is an enhanced version of the
Dual Input Fast Program instruction, allowing to transmit address across two data lines.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the DIEFP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather than using several DIEFP
sequences, each containing only a few bytes.
23/180
Operating features
5.1.5
N25Q128 - 3 V
Quad Input Fast Program
The Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction makes it possible to program up to 256
bytes using 4 input pins at the same time (by changing bits from 1 to 0).
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the QIFP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather than using several QIFP sequences
each containing only a few bytes.
5.1.6
Quad Input Extended Fast Program
The Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP) instruction is an enhanced version of the
Quad Input Fast Program instruction, allowing parallel input on the 4 input pins, including
the address being sent to the device.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the QIEFP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather than using several QIEFP
sequences each containing only a few bytes.
5.1.7
Subsector erase, sector erase and bulk erase
The page program (PP) instruction allows bits to be reset from ‘1’ to’0’. In order to do this the
bytes of memory need to be erased to all 1s (FFh).
This can be achieved as follows:
„
a subsector at a time, using the subsector erase (SSE) instruction (only available on
the 8 boot sectors at the bottom or top addressable area of a device with a dedicated
part number); See Section 16: Ordering information;
„
a sector at a time, using the sector erase (SE) instruction;
„
throughout the entire memory, using the bulk erase (BE) instruction.
This starts an internal erase cycle (of duration tSSE, tSE or tBE). The erase instruction must
be preceded by a write enable (WREN) instruction.
5.1.8
Polling during a write, program or erase cycle
A further improvement in the time to Write Status Register (WRSR), POTP, PP,
DIFP,DIEFP,QIFP, QIEFP or Erase (SSE, SE or BE) can be achieved by not waiting for the
worst case delay (tW, tPP, tSSE, tSE, or tBE). The application program can monitor if the
required internal operation is completed, by polling the dedicated register bits to establish
when the previous Write, Program or Erase cycle is complete.
The information on the memory being in progress for a Program, Erase, or Write instruction
can be checked either on the Write In Progress (WIP) bit of the Status Register or in the
Program/Erase Controller bit of the Flag Status Register.
Note:
The Program/Erase Controller bit is the opposite state of the WIP bit in the Status Register.
In the Flag Status Register additional information can be checked, as eventual
Program/Erase failures by mean of the Program or erase Error bits.
24/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
5.1.9
Operating features
Active power and standby power modes
When Chip Select (S) is Low, the device is selected, and in the active power mode.
When Chip Select (S) is High, the device is deselected, but could remain in the active power
mode until all internal cycles have completed (program, erase, write status register). The
device then goes in to the standby power mode. The device consumption drops to ICC1.
5.1.10
Hold (or Reset) condition
The Hold (HOLD) signal is used to pause serial communications with the device without
resetting the clocking sequence. However, taking this signal Low does not terminate any
write status register, program or erase cycle that is currently in progress.
To enter the hold condition, the device must be selected, with Chip Select (S) Low.
The hold condition starts on the falling edge of the Hold (HOLD) signal, provided that the
Serial Clock (C) is Low (as shown in Figure 7).
The hold condition ends on the rising edge of the Hold (HOLD) signal, provided that the
Serial Clock (C) is Low.
If the falling edge does not coincide with Serial Clock (C) being Low, the hold condition
starts after Serial Clock (C) next goes Low. Similarly, if the rising edge does not coincide
with Serial Clock (C) being Low, the hold condition ends after Serial Clock (C) next goes
Low (this is shown in Figure 7).
During the hold condition, the serial data output (DQ1) is high impedance, and serial data
input (DQ0) and Serial Clock (C) are don’t care.
Normally, the device is kept selected, with Chip Select (S) driven Low for the whole duration
of the hold condition. This is to ensure that the state of the internal logic remains unchanged
from the moment of entering the hold condition.
If Chip Select (S) goes High while the device is in the Hold condition, this has the effect of
resetting the internal logic of the device. To restart communication with the device, it is
necessary to drive Hold (HOLD) High, and then to drive Chip Select (S) Low. This prevents
the device from going back to the hold condition.
Figure 7.
Hold condition activation
C
HOLD
Hold
condition
(standard use)
Hold
condition
(non-standard use)
AI02029D
Reset functionality is available instead of Hold in parts with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
Driving Reset (Reset) Low while an internal operation is in progress will affect this operation
(write, program or erase cycle) and data may be lost. On Reset going Low, the device enters
25/180
Operating features
N25Q128 - 3 V
the reset mode and a time of tRHSL is then required before the device can be reselected by
driving Chip Select (S) Low. For the value of tRHSL, see Table 32.: AC Characteristics. All
the lock bits are reset to 0 after a Reset Low pulse.
The Hold/Reset feature is not available when the Hold (Reset) / DQ3 pin is used as I/O
(DQ3 functionality) during Quad Instructions: QOFR, QIOFR,QIFP and QIEFP.
The Hold/Reset feature can be disabled by using of the bit 4 of the VECR.
26/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
5.2
Operating features
Dual SPI (DIO-SPI) Protocol
In the Dual SPI (DIO-SPI) protocol all the instructions, addresses and I/O data are
transmitted on two data lines. All the functionality available in the Extended SPI protocol is
also available in the DIO-SPI protocol. The DIO-SPI instructions are comparable with the
Extended SPI instructions; however, in DIO-SPI, the instructions are multiplexed on the two
data lines, DQ0 and DQ1.
The only exceptions are the READ, Quad Read, and Program instructions, which are not
available in DIO-SPI protocol, and the RDID instruction, which is replaced in the DIO-SPI
protocol by the Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction.
The Multiple I/O Read Identification Instruction reads just the standard SPI electronic ID (3
bytes), while the Extended SPI protocol RDID instruction allows access to the UID bytes.
To help the application code port from Extended SPI to DIO-SPI protocol, the instructions
available in the DIO-SPI protocol have the same operation code as the Extended SPI
protocol, the only exception being the MIORDID instruction.
5.2.1
Multiple Read Identification
The Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction is available to read the device
electronic ID.With respect to the RDID instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, the output
data, shifted out on the 2 data lines DQ0 and DQ1.
Since the read ID instruction in the DIO-SPI protocol is limited to 3 bytes of the standard
electronic ID, the UID bytes are not read with the MIORDID instruction
5.2.2
Dual Command Fast reading
Reading the memory data multiplexing the instruction, the addresses and the output data on
2 data lines can be achieved in DIO-SPI protocol by mean of the Dual Command Fast Read
instruction, that has 3 instruction codes (BBh, 3Bh and 0Bh) to help the application code
porting from Extended SPI protocol to DIO-SPI protocol. Of course quad and single I/O
Read instructions are not available in DIO-SPI mode.
For Dual Command fast read instructions the number of dummy clock cycles is configurable
by using VCR bits [7:4] or NVCR bits [15:12].
After a successful reading instruction, a reduced tSHSL equal to 20ns is allowed to further
improve random access time (in all the other cases tSHSL should be at least 50 ns). See
Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
5.2.3
Page programming
Programming the memory by transmitting the instruction, addresses and the output data on
2 data lines can be achieved in DIO-SPI protocol by using the Dual Command Page
Program instruction, that has 3 instruction codes (D2h, A2h and 02h) to help port from
Extended SPI protocol to DIO-SPI protocol
Quad and single input Program instructions are not available in DIO-SPI mode.
27/180
Operating features
N25Q128 - 3 V
The DIO-SPI protocol is similar to the Extended SPI protocol i.e., to program one data byte
two instructions are required:
„
Write Enable (WREN), which is one byte, and a
„
Dual Command Page Program (DCPP) sequence, which consists of four bytes plus
data.
This is followed by the internal Program cycle (of duration tPP).
To spread this overhead, the Dual Command Page Program (DCPP) instruction allows up to
256 bytes to be programmed at a time (changing bits from 1 to 0), provided that they are
consecutive addresses on the same page of memory.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the DCPP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence versus using several DCPP sequences
with each containing only a few bytes. See Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
5.2.4
Subsector Erase, Sector Erase and Bulk Erase
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol, in the DIO-SPI protocol to erase the memory bytes to
all 1s (FFh) the Subsector Erase (SSE), the Sector Erase (SE) and the Bulk Erase (BE)
instructions are available. These instructions start an internal Erase cycle (of duration tSSE,
tSE or tBE).
The Erase instruction must be preceded by a Write Enable (WREN) instruction.
Subsector Erase is only available on the 8 Bottom (Top) boot sectors, and is not available in
uniform architecture parts
5.2.5
Polling during a Write, Program or Erase cycle
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol, in the DIO-SPI protocol it is possible to monitor if the
internal write, program or erase operation is completed, by polling the dedicated register bits
by using the Read Status Register (RDSR) or Read Flag Status Register (RFSR)
instructions, the only obvious difference is that instruction codes, addresses and output data
are transmitted across two data lines.
5.2.6
Read and Modify registers
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol, the only obvious difference is that instruction codes,
addresses and output data are transmitted across two data lines
5.2.7
Active Power and Standby Power modes
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol, when Chip Select (S) is Low, the device is selected,
and in the Active Power mode. When Chip Select (S) is High, the device is deselected, but
could remain in the Active Power mode until all internal cycles have completed (Program,
Erase, Write Cycles). The device then goes in to the Standby Power mode. The device
consumption drops to ICC1.
5.2.8
HOLD (or Reset) condition
The HOLD (or Reset i.e. for parts having the reset functionality instead of hold pin) signal
has exactly the same behavior in DIO-SPI protocol as do in Extended SPI protocol, so
please refer to section 5.1.10, Hold (or Reset) condition” in the Extend SPI protocol section
for further details.
28/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
5.3
Operating features
Quad SPI (QIO-SPI)Protocol
In the Quad SPI (QIO-SPI) protocol all the Instructions, addresses and I/O data are
transmitted on four data lines, with the exception of the polling instructions performed during
a Program or Erase cycle performed with VPP, in this case the device temporarily goes in
Extended SPI protocol. The protocol again becomes QIO-SPI as soon as the VPP voltage
goes low.
All the functionality available in the Extended SPI protocol are also available in the QIO-SPI
mode, with equivalent instruction transmitted on the 4 data lines DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3.
The exceptions are the READ, Dual Read and Dual Program instructions, that are not
available in QIO-SPI protocol, and the RDID instruction, that is replaced in the QIO-SPI
protocol by the Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction. The Multiple I/O
Read Instruction reads just the standard SPI electronic ID (3 bytes), while with the Extended
SPI protocol RDID instruction is possible to access also the UID bytes.
To help the application code port from Extended SPI to QIO-SPI protocol, the instructions
available in the QIO-SPI protocol have the same operation code as in the Extended SPI
protocol, the only exception is the MIORDID instruction.
5.3.1
Multiple Read Identification
The Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction is available to read the device
electronic ID. With respect to the RDID instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, the output
data, shifted out on the 4 data lines DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3.
Since in the QIO-SPI protocol the Read ID instruction is limited to 3 bytes of the standard
electronic ID, the UID bytes are not read with the MIORDID instruction.
5.3.2
Quad Command Fast reading
The Array Data can be read by the Quad Command Fast Read instruction using 3
instructions (EBh, 6Bh and 0Bh) to help the application code port from Extended SPI
protocol to DIO-SPI protocol. The instruction, address and output data are transmitted
across 4 data lines.
The Dual and Single I/O Read instructions are not available in QIO-SPI protocol.
5.3.3
QUAD Command Page programming
The memory can be programmed in QIO-SPI protocol by the Quad Command Page
Program instruction using (02h, 12h and 32h). The instruction, address and input data are
transmitted across 4 data lines
The Dual and Single I/O Program instructions are not available in QIO-SPI protocol
Programming the memory by multiplexing the instruction, the addresses and the output data
on 4 wires can be achieved in QIO-SPI protocol by mean of the Quad Command Page
Program instruction, that has 3 instruction codes (02h, 12h and 32h) to help the application
code porting from Extended SPI protocol to QIO-SPI protocol.
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol in the QIO-SPI protocol, to program one data byte two
instructions are required:
„
Write Enable (WREN), which is one byte, and
„
Quad Command Page Program (QCPP) sequence, which consists of instruction (one
byte), address (3 bytes) and input data.
29/180
Operating features
N25Q128 - 3 V
This is followed by the internal Program cycle (of duration tPP).
To spread this overhead, the Quad Command Page Program (QCPP) instruction allows up
to 256 bytes to be programmed at a time (changing bits from 1 to 0), provided that they are
in consecutive addresses on the same page of memory.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the QCPP instruction to program all
consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence versus using several QCPP sequences
with each containing only a few bytes. See Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
The QCPP instruction is transmitted across 4 data lines except when VPP is raised to
VPPH.
The VPP can be raised to VPPH to decrease programming time (provided that the bit 3 of
the VECR has been set to 0 in advance). When bit 3 of VECR is set to 0 after the Quad
Command Page Program instruction sequence has been received, the memory temporarily
goes in Extended SPI protocol, and is possible to perform polling instructions (checking the
WIP bit of the Status Register or the Program/Erase Controller bit of the Flag Status
Register) or Program/Erase Suspend instruction even if DQ2 is temporarily used in this VPP
functionality. The memory automatically comes back in QIO-SPI protocol as soon as the
VPP pin goes Low.
5.3.4
Subsector Erase, Sector Erase and Bulk Erase
Similar to the Extended SPI protocol, Subsector Erase (SSE)(1), the Sector Erase (SE) and
the Bulk Erase (BE) instructions are used to erase the memory in the QIO-SPI protocol.
These instructions start an internal Erase cycle (of duration tSSE, tSE or tBE).
The Erase instruction must be preceded by a Write Enable (WREN) instruction.
The erase instructions are transmitted across 4 data lines unless the VPP is raised to
VPPH.
The VPP can be raised to VPPH to decrease erasing time, provided that the bit 3 of the
VECR has been set to 0 in advance. In this case, after the erase instruction sequence has
been received, the memory temporarily goes in extended SPI protocol, and it is possible to
perform polling instructions (checking the WIP bit of the Status Register or the
Program/Erase Controller bit of the Flag Status Register) or Program/Erase Suspend
instruction even if DQ2 is temporarily used in this VPP functionality. The memory
automatically comes back in QIO-SPI protocol as soon as the VPP pin goes Low.
Note:
Subsector Erase is only available on the 8 Bottom (Top) boot sectors, and is not available in
uniform architecture parts
5.3.5
Polling during a Write, Program or Erase cycle
It is possible to check if the internal write, program or erase operation is completed, by
polling the dedicated register bits of the Read Status Register (RDSR) or Read Flag Status
Register (FSR).
When the Program or Erase cycle is performed with the VPP, the device temporarily goes in
single I/O SPI mode. The protocol became again QIO-SPI as soon as the VPP pin voltage
goes low.
30/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
5.3.6
Operating features
Read and Modify registers
The read and modify register instructions are available and behave in QIO-SPI protocol
exactly as they do in Extended SPI protocol, the only difference is that instruction codes,
addresses and output data are transmitted across 4 data lines.
5.3.7
Active Power and Standby Power modes
Exactly as in Extended SPI protocol, when Chip Select (S) is Low, the device is selected,
and in the Active Power mode. When Chip Select (S) is High, the device is deselected, but
could remain in the Active Power mode until all internal (Program, Erase, Write) Cycles
have completed. The device then goes in to the Standby Power mode. The device
consumption drops to ICC1.
5.3.8
HOLD (or Reset) condition
The HOLD (Hold) feature (or Reset feature, for parts having the reset functionality instead of
hold) is disabled in QIO-SPI protocol when the device is selected: the Hold (or Reset)/ DQ3
pin always behaves as an I/O pin (DQ3 function) when the device is deselected. For parts
with reset functionality, it is still possible to reset the memory when it is deselected (C signal
high).
5.3.9
VPP pin Enhanced Supply Voltage feature
It is possible in the QIO-SPI protocol to use the VPP pin as an enhanced supply voltage, but
the intention to use VPP as accelerated supply voltage must be declared by setting bit 3 of
the VECR to 0.
In this case, to accelerate the Program cycle the VPP pin must be raised to VPPH after the
device has received the last data to be programmed within 200ms. If the VPP is not raised
within 200ms, the program operation starts with the standard internal cycle speed as if the
Vpp high voltage were not used, and a flag error appears on Flag Status Register bit 3".
31/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
6
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
The device features many different registers to store, in volatile or non volatile mode, many
parameters and operating configurations:
„
Legacy SPI Status Register
„
3 configuration registers:
–
Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR), 16 bits
–
Volatile Configuration Register (VCR), 8 bits
–
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (VECR), 8 bits
The Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR) affects the memory configuration starting
from the successive power-on. It can be used to make the memory start in a determined
condition.
The VCR and VECR affect the memory configuration after every execution of the related
Write Volatile configuration Register (WRVCR) and Write Enhanced Volatile Configuration
register (WRVECR) instructions. These instructions overwrite the memory configuration set
at POR by NVCR.
As described in Figure 8.: Non Volatile and Volatile configuration Register Scheme, the
working condition of the memory is set by an internal configuration register, which is not
accessible by the user. The working parameters of the internal configuration register are
loaded from the NVCR during the boot phase of the device. In this sense the NVCR can be
seen as having the default settings of the memory.
During the normal life of the application, every time a write volatile or enhanced volatile
configuration register instruction is performed, the new configuration parameters set in the
volatile registers are also copied in the internal configuration register, thus instantly affecting
the memory behavior. Please note that on the next power on the memory will start again in
the working protocol set by the Non Volatile Register parameters.
32/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Figure 8.
Non Volatile and Volatile configuration Register Scheme
NVCR
(Non Volatile Configuratio n Register)
Register download executed only
during the power on phase
VCR (Volatile Co nfiguratio n Register)
and VECR (Volatile Enhanced
Co nfiguratio n Register)
Registers download executed after
a WRVCR or WRVECR
instructions, it overwrites NVCR
configurations on iCR
iCR
(internal Configuration Register)
Device behaviour
A Flag Status Register (FSR), 8 bits, is also available to check the status of the device,
detecting possible errors or a Program/Erase internal cycle in progress.
Each register can be read and modified by means of dedicated instructions in all the 3
protocols (Extended SPI, DIO-SPI, and QIO-SPI).
Reading time for all registers is comparable; writing time instead is very different: NVCR bits
are set as Flash Cell memory content requiring a longer time to perform internal writing
cycles. See Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
33/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
6.1
N25Q128 - 3 V
Legacy SPI Status Register
The Status Register contains a number of status and control bits that can be read or set by
specific instructions: Read Status Register (RDSR) and Write Status Register (WRSR). This
is available in all the 3 protocols (Extended SPI, DIO-SPI, and QIO-SPI).
Table 2.
Status register format
b7
SRWD
b0
BP3
TB
BP2
BP1
BP0
WEL
WIP
Status register write protect
Top/bottom bit
Block protect bits
Write enable latch bit
Write in progress bit
6.1.1
WIP bit
The Write In Progress (WIP) bit set to 1 indicates that the memory is busy with a Write
Status Register, Program or Erase cycle. 0 indicates no cycle is in progress.
6.1.2
WEL bit
The Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit set to 1 indicates that the internal Write Enable Latch is
set. When set to 0 the internal Write Enable Latch is reset and no Write Status Register,
Program or Erase instruction is accepted.
6.1.3
BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0 bits
The Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits are non-volatile. They define the size of the
area to be software protected against Program and Erase instructions. These bits are
written with the Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction. When one or more of the Block
Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits is set to 1, the relevant memory area, as defined in Table
9.: Protected area sizes (TB bit = 0) and Table 10.: Protected area sizes (TB bit = 1),
becomes protected against all program and erase instructions. The Block Protect (BP3,
BP2, BP1, BP0) bits can be written provided that the Hardware Protected mode has not
been set. The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction is executed if, and only if, all Block Protect (BP3,
BP2, BP1, BP0) bits are 0.
6.1.4
TB bit
The Top/Bottom (TB) bit is non-volatile. It can be set and reset with the Write Status Register
(WRSR) instruction provided that the Write Enable (WREN) instruction has been issued.
34/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
The Top/Bottom (TB) bit is used in conjunction with the Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0)
bits to determine if the protected area defined by the Block Protect bits starts from the top or
the bottom of the memory array:
„
When TB is reset to '0' (default value), the area protected by the Block Protect bits
starts from the top of the memory array.
„
When TB is set to '1', the area protected by the Block Protect bits starts from the bottom
of the memory array.
The TB bit cannot be written when the SRWD bit is set to '1' and the W pin is driven Low.
6.1.5
SRWD bit
The Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit is operated in conjunction with the Write
Protect (W/VPP) signal. The Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit and the Write Protect
(W/VPP) signal allow the device to be put in the hardware protected mode (when the Status
Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit is set to '1', and Write Protect ((W/VPP) is driven Low). In
this mode, the non-volatile bits of the Status Register (TB, BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) become
read-only bits and the Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction is no longer accepted for
execution.
6.2
Non Volatile Configuration Register
The Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR) bits affects the default memory
configuration after power-on. It can be used to make the memory start in the configuration to
fit the application requirements.
The device is delivered with Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR) bits all erased to 1
(FFFFh).
The purpose of the NVCR is to define the default memory settings after the power-on
sequence related to many features:
„
The number of dummy clock cycle for fast read instructions,
„
XIP mode configurations,
„
output driver strengths,
„
fast POR sequence,
„
Reset (or Hold) disabling
„
Multiple I/O protocol enabling.
The NVCR can be read by the Read Non Volatile Configuration Register (RDNVCR)
instruction and written by the Write Non Volatile Configuration Register (WRNVCR) in all the
3 available SPI protocols. See the sections that follow as well as Table 3.: Non-Volatile
Configuration Register.
35/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Table 3.
Non-Volatile Configuration Register
Bit
NVCR<15:12>
NVCR<11:9>
NVCR<8:6>
36/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Parameter
Value
Description
0000
As '1111'
0001
1
0010
2
0011
3
0100
4
0101
5
0110
6
0111
7
1000
Dummy clock
1001
cycle
8
9
1010
10
1011
11
1100
12
1101
13
1110
14
1111
Target on maximum
allowed frequency fc
(108MHz) and to
guarantee backward
compatibility (default)
000
XIP for SIO Read
001
XIP for DOFR
010
XIP for DIOFR
011
XIP for QOFR
100
XIP for QIOFR
101
reserved
110
reserved
111
XIP disabled (default)
000
reserved
001
90
010
Output Driver
011
Strength
100
60
101
20
110
15
XIP enabling
at POR
45
reserved
Note
To optimize instruction execution
(FASTREAD, DOFR,DIOFR,QOFR,
QIOFR, ROTP) according to the frequency
Impedance at Vcc/2
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 3.
Bit
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Non-Volatile Configuration Register
Parameter
Value
Description
111
NVCR<5>
NVCR<4>
NVCR<3>
NVCR<2>
NVCR<1:0>
6.2.1
Note
30 (default)
0
Enabled
POR phase < 100us only read available
1
Disabled (default)
POR phase ~ 700us all instructions
available
Reset/Hold
disable
0
disabled
1
enabled (default)
Quad Input
Command
0
enabled
1
disabled (default)
Dual Input
Command
0
enabled
1
disabled (default)
Reserved
xx
Don't care
Fast POR x
READ
Disable Pad Hold/Reset functionality
Enable command on four input line
Enable command on two input line
Default value = "11"
Dummy clock cycle NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 15 to 12)
The bits from 15 to 12 of the Non Volatile Configuration register store the default settings for
the dummy clock cycles number after the fast read instructions (in all the 3 available
protocols). The dummy clock cycles number can be set from 1 up to 15 as described here,
according to operating frequency (the higher is the operating frequency, the bigger must be
the dummy clock cycle number) to optimize the fast read instructions performance.
The default values of these bits allow the memory to be safely used with fast read
instructions at the maximum frequency (108 MHz). Please note that if the dummy clock
number is not sufficient for the operating frequency, the memory reads wrong data.
Table 4.
Maximum allowed frequency (MHz)
Maximum allowed frequency (MHz)(1)
Dummy Clock
FASTREAD
DOFR
DIOFR
QOFR
QIOFR
1
50
50
39
43
20
2
95
85
59
56
39
3
105
95
75
70
49
4
108
105
88
83
59
5
108
108
94
94
69
6
108
108
105
105
78
7
108
108
108
108
86
8
108
108
108
108
95
9
108
108
108
108
105
10
108
108
108
108
108
1. All values are guaranteed by characterization and not 100% tested in production.
37/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
6.2.2
N25Q128 - 3 V
XIP NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 11 to 9)
The bits from 11 to 9 of the Non Volatile Configuration register store the default settings for
the XIP operation, allowing the memory to start working directly on the required XIP mode
after successive POR sequence: the device then accepts only address on one, two, or four
wires (skipping the instruction) depending on the NVCR XIP bits settings.
The default settings for the XIP bits of the NVCR enable the memory to start working in
Extended SPI mode after the POR sequence (XIP directly after POR is disabled).
6.2.3
Output Driver Strength NV configuration bits (NVCR bits from 8 to 6)
The bits from 8 to 6 of the Non Volatile Configuration register store the default settings for
the output driver strength, enabling to optimize the impedance at Vcc/2 output voltage for
the specific application.
The default values of Output Driver Strength bits of the NVCR set the output impedance at
Vcc/2 equal to 30 Ohms.
6.2.4
Fast POR NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 5)
The bit 5 of the NVCR enables the FAST POR sequence to speed up the application boot
phase before the first READ instruction: if enabled, the FAST POR allows to perform the first
read operation after less than 100us. Please note that this timing is valid only for the reading
operations: if a modify instruction is then required, after the first WREN instruction the
complete POR phase will be performed, resulting in latency time between the WREN and
the receiving of the modify instruction (~500us). During this latency time, when the power on
second phase is running, no instruction will be accepted except the standard polling
instructions either on the Flag Status register or in the Status Register.
The default values of Fast POR bit of the NVCR is set to disable the Fast POR feature, in
this case the POR sequence requires the standard value of ~500us and after the first
WREN instruction no relevant latency time is needed.
6.2.5
Hold (Reset) disable NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 4)
The Hold (RESET) disable bit can be used to disable the Hold (Reset) functionality of the
Hold (Reset) / DQ3 pin as described in Table 3.: Non-Volatile Configuration Register. This
feature can be useful to avoid accidental Hold or Reset condition entries in applications that
never require the Hold (Reset) functionality.
The default values of Hold (Reset) bit of the NVCR is set to enable the Hold (Reset)
functionality.
Note:
Reset functionality is available instead of Hold in devices with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
6.2.6
Quad Input NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 3)
The Quad Input NV configuration bit can be used to make the memory start working in QIOSPI protocol directly after the power on sequence. The products are delivered with this set
to 1, making the memory default in Extended SPI protocol, if the application sets this bit to 0
the device will enter in QIO-SPI protocol right after the next power on.
Please note that in case both QIO-SPI and DIO-SPI are enabled (both bit 3 and bit 2 of the
Non Volatile Configuration Register set to 0), the memory will work in QIO-SPI.
38/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
6.2.7
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Dual Input NV configuration bit (NVCR bit 2)
The Dual Input NV configuration bit can be used to make the memory start working in DIOSPI protocol directly after the power on sequence. The products are delivered with this set
to 1, making the memory default in Extended SPI protocol, if the application sets this bit to 0
the device will enter in QIO-SPI protocol right after the next power on.
Please note that in case both QIO-SPI and DIO-SPI are enabled (both bit 3 and bit 2 of the
Non Volatile Configuration Register set to 0), the memory will work in QIO-SPI.
6.3
Volatile Configuration Register
The Volatile Configuration Register (VCR) affects the memory configuration after every
execution of Write Volatile Configuration Register (WRVCR) instruction: this instruction
overwrite the memory configuration set at POR by the Non Volatile Configuration Register
(NVCR). Its purpose is to define the dummy clock cycles number and to make the device
ready to enter in the required XIP mode.
39/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Table 5.
Bit
VCR<7:4>
Volatile Configuration Register
Parameter
Value
As '1111'
0001
1
0010
2
0011
3
0100
4
0101
5
0110
6
0111
7
1000
Dummy clock
1001
cycle
8
10
1011
11
1100
12
1101
13
1110
14
1111
Target on maximum
allowed frequency fc
(108MHz) and to
guarantee backward
compatibility (default)
XIP
6.3.1
Reserved
9
1010
1
VCR<2:0>
Description
0000
0
VCR<3>
N25Q128 - 3 V
xxx
Note
To optimize instruction execution
(FASTREAD, DOFR,DIOFR,QOFR,
QIOFR, ROTP) according to the frequency
Ready to enter XIP mode To make the data on DQ0 during the first
dummy clock NOT “Don’t Care.” For
devices with feature set digit equal to 2 or 4
XIP disabled (default)
in the part number (Basic XiP), this bit is
always Don't Care"
reserved
Fixed value = 000b
Dummy clock cycle: VCR bits 7 to 4
The bits from 7 to 4 of the Volatile Configuration Register, as the bits from 15 to 12 of the
Volatile Configuration register, set the dummy clock cycles number after the fast read
instructions (in all the 3 available protocols). The dummy clock cycles number can be set
from 1 up to 15 as described in Table 5.: Volatile Configuration Register, according to
operating frequency (the higher is the operating frequency, the bigger must be the dummy
clock cycle number, according to Table 4.: Maximum allowed frequency (MHz)) to optimize
the fast read instructions performance.
Note:
40/180
If the dummy clock number is not sufficient for the operating frequency, the memory reads
wrong data.
N25Q128 - 3 V
6.3.2
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
XIP Volatile Configuration bits (VCR bit 3)
The bit 3 of the Volatile Configuration Register is the XIP enabling bit, this bit must be set to
0 to enable the memory working on XIP mode. For devices with a feature set digit equal to 2
or 4 in the part number (Basic XiP), this bit is always Don't Care, and it is possible to operate
the memory in XIP mode without setting it to 0. See Section 16: Ordering information.
6.4
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (VECR) affects the memory configuration
after every execution of Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (WRVECR)
instruction: this instruction overwrite the memory configuration set during the POR
sequence by the Non Volatile Configuration Register (NVCR). Its purpose is:
„
enabling of QIO-SPI protocol and DIO-SPI protocol
Warning:
WARNING: in case of both QIO-SPI and DIO-SPI enabled, the
memory works in QIO-SPI
„
HOLD (Reset) functionality disabling
„
To enable the VPP functionality in Quad I/O modify operations
„
To define output driver strength (3 bit)
41/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Table 6.
Bit
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
Parameter
Value
Description
Quad Input
Command
0
Enabled
1
Disabled (default)
Dual Input
Command
0
Enabled
1
Disabled (default)
VECR<5>
Reserved
x
Reserved
Reset/Hold
disable
0
Disabled
VECR<4>
1
Enabled (default)
Accelerator
pin enable in
QIO-SPI
protocol or in
QIFP/QIEFP
0
Enabled
VECR<7>
VECR<6>
VECR<3>
VECR<2:0>
6.4.1
Note
Enable command on four input lines
Enable command on two input lines
Fixed value = 0b
Disable Pad Hold/Reset functionality
1
Disabled (default)
000
reserved
001
90
010
60
Output Driver 011
Strength
100
45
101
20
110
15
111
30 (default)
reserved
The bit must be considered in case of QIFP,
QIEFP, or QIO-SPI protocol. It is “Don’t
Care” otherwise.
Impedance at VCC/2
Quad Input Command VECR<7>
The Quad Input Command configuration bit can be used to make the memory start working
in QIO-SPI protocol directly after the Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
(WRVECR) instruction. The default value of this bit is 1, corresponding to Extended SPI
protocol, If this bit is set to 0 the memory works in QIO-SPI protocol. If VECR bit 7 is set
back to 1 the memory start working again in Extended SPI protocol, unless the bit 6 is set to
0 (in this case the memory start working in DIO-SPI mode).
Please note that in case both QIO-SPI and DIO-SPI are enabled (both bit 7and bit 6 of the
VECR set to 0), the memory will work in QIO-SPI.
6.4.2
Dual Input Command VECR<6>
The Dual Input Command configuration bit can be used to make the memory start working
in DIO-SPI protocol directly after the Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
(WVECR) instruction. The default value of this bit is 1, corresponding to Extended SPI
protocol, if this bit is set to 0 the memory works in DIO-SPI protocol (unless the Volatile
Enhanced Configuration Register bit 7 is also set to 0). If the Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register bit 6 is set back to 1 the memory start working again in Extended SPI
protocol.
42/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Please note that in case both QIO-SPI and DIO-SPI are enabled (both bit 7 and bit 6 of the
VECR are set to 0), the memory will work in QIO-SPI.
6.4.3
Reset/Hold disable VECR<4>
The Hold (RESET) disable bit can be used to disable the Hold (Reset) functionality of the
Hold (Reset) / DQ3 pin right after the Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
(WVECR) instruction. This feature can be useful to avoid accidental Hold or Reset condition
entries in applications that never require the Hold (Reset) functionality. If this bit is set to 0
the Hold (Reset) functionality is disabled, it is possible to enable it back by setting this bit to
1.
Please note that after the next power on the Hold (Reset) functionality will be enabled again
unless the bit 4 of the Non Volatile Configuration Register is set to 0.
Note:
Reset functionality is available instead of Hold in devices with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
6.4.4
Accelerator pin enable: QIO-SPI protocol / QIFP/QIEFP VECR<3>
The bit 3 of the Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register determine whether is possible or
not to use the Vpp accelerating voltage to speed up internal modify operation with Quad
program and erase instructions (both in Extended or QIO-SPI protocols).
If we want to use the Vpp voltage with Quad I/O modify instructions, we must set previously
this bit to 0 (his default value is 1, in this case the Vpp pin functionality is disabled in all
Quad I/O operations: both in Extended SPI and QIO-SPI protocols).
If the Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register bit 3 is set to 0, using the QIO-SPI protocol,
after a Quad Command Page Program instruction or an Erase instruction is received (with
all input data in the Program case) and the memory is de-selected, the protocol temporarily
switches to Extended SPI protocol until Vpp passes from Vpph to normal I/O value (this
transition is mandatory to come back to QIO-SPI protocol), to enable the possibility to
perform polling instructions (to check if the internal modify cycle is finished by means of the
WIP bit of the Status Register or of the Program/Erase controller bit of the Flag Status
register) or Program/Erase Suspend instruction even if the DQ2 pin is temporarily used in
his Vpp functionality.
If the Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register bit 3 is set to 0, after any quad modify
instruction (both in Extended SPI protocol and QIO-SPI protocol) there is a maximum
allowed time-out of 200ms after the last instruction input is received and the memory is deselected to raise the Vpp signal to Vpph, otherwise the modify instruction start at normal
speed, without the Vpph enhancement, and a flag error appears on Flag Status Register bit
3.
6.4.5
Output Driver Strength VECR<2:0>
The bits from 2 to 0 of the VECR set the value of the output driver strength, enabling to
optimize the impedance at Vcc/2 output voltage for the specific application as described in
Table 6.: Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register.
The default values of Output Driver Strength is set by the dedicated bits of the Non Volatile
Configuration Register (NVCR), the parts are delivered with the output impedance at Vcc/2
equal to 30 Ohms.
43/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
6.5
N25Q128 - 3 V
Flag Status Register
The Flag Status Register is a powerful tool to investigate the status of the device, checking
information regarding what is actually doing the memory and detecting possible error
conditions.
The Flag status register is composed by 8 bit.Three bits (Program/Erase Controller bit,
Erase Suspend bit and Program Suspend bit) are a “Status Indicator bit”, they are set and
reset automatically by the memory. Four bits (Erase error bit, Program error bit, VPP 1 to 0
error bit and Protection error bit) are “Error Indicators bits”, they are set by the memory
when some program or erase operation fails or the user tries to perform a forbidden
operation. The user can clear the Error Indicators bits by mean of the Clear Flag Status
Register (CLFSR) instruction.
All the Flag Status Register bits can be read by mean of the Read Status Register (RFSR)
instruction.
44/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
Table 7.
Flag Status Register
BIT
6.5.1
Description
Note
7
P/E Controller (not WIP)
Status
6
Erase Suspend
Status
5
Erase
Error
4
Program
Error
3
VPP
Error
2
Program Suspend
Status
1
Protection
Error
0
RESERVED
P/E Controller Status bit
The bit 7 of the Flag Status register represents the Program/Erase Controller Status bit, It
indicates whether there is a Program/Erase internal cycle active. When P/E Controller
Status bit is Low (FSR<7>=0) the device is busy; when the bit is High (FSR<7>=1) the
device is ready to process a new command.
This bit has the same meaning of Write In Progress (WIP) bit of the standard SPI Status
Register, but with opposite logic: FSR<7> = not WIP
It's possible to make the polling instructions, to check if the internal modify operations are
finished, both on the Flag Status register bit 7 or on WIP bit of the Status Register.
6.5.2
Erase Suspend Status bit
The bit 6 of the Flag Status register represents the Erase Suspend Status bit, It indicates
that an Erase operation has been suspended or is going to be suspended.
The bit is set (FSR<6>=1) within the Erase Suspend Latency time, that is as soon as the
Program/Erase Suspend command (PES) has been issued, therefore the device may still
complete the operation before entering the Suspend Mode.
The Erase Suspend Status should be considered valid when the P/E Controller bit is high
(FSR<7>=1).
When a Program/Erase Resume command (PER) is issued the Erase Suspend Status bit
returns Low (FSR<6>=0)
6.5.3
Erase Status bit
The bit 5 of the Flag Status Register represents the Erase Status bit. It indicates an erase
failure or a protection error when an erase operation is issued.
When the Erase Status bit is High (FSR<5>=1) after an Erase failure that means that the
P/E Controller has applied the maximum pulses number to the portion to be erased and still
failed to verify that it has correctly erased.
The Erase Status bit should be read once the P/E Controller Status bit is High.
45/180
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
N25Q128 - 3 V
The Erase Status bit is related to all possible erase operations: Sector Erase, Sub Sector
Erase, and Bulk Erase in all the three available protocols (SPI, DIO-SPI and QIO-SPI).
Once the bit 5 is set High, it can only be reset Low (FSR<5>=0) by a Clear Flag Status
Register command (CLFSR).
If set High it should be reset before a new Erase command is issued; otherwise the new
command will appear to fail.
6.5.4
Program Status bit
The bit 4 of the Flag Status Register represents the Program Status bit. It indicates:
„
a Program failure
„
an attempt to program a '1' on '0' when VPP=VPPH (only when the pattern is a multiple
of 64 bits, otherwise this bit is "Don't care").
„
a protection error when a program is issued
When the Program Status bit is High (FSR<4>=1) after a Program failure that means that
the P/E Controller has applied the maximum pulses number to the bytes and it still failed to
verify that the required data have been correctly programmed.
After an attempt to program '1' on '0', the FSR<4> only goes High (FSR<4>=1) if
VPP=VPPH and the data pattern is a multiple of 64 bits: if VPP is not VPPH, FSR<4>
remains Low and the attempt is not shown while if VPP is equal to VPPh but the pattern is
not a 64 bits multiple the bit 4 is Don't Care. The Program Status bit should be read once the
P/E Controller Status bit is High.
The Program Status bit is related to all possible program operations in the Extended SPI
protocol: Page Program, Dual and Quad Input Fast Program, Dual and Quad Input
Extended Fast Program, and OTP Program.
The Program Status bit is related to the following program operations in the DIO-SPI and
QIO-SPI protocols: Dual and Quad Command Page program and OTP program.
Once the bit is set High, it can only be reset Low (FSR<4>=0) by a Clear Flag Status
Register command (CLFSR). If set High it should be reset before a new Program command
is issued, otherwise the new command will appear to fail.
6.5.5
VPP Status bit
The bit 3 of the Flag Status Register represents the VPP Status bit. It indicates an invalid
voltage on the VPP pin during Program and Erase operations. The VPP pin is sampled at
the beginning of a Program or Erase operation.
If VPP becomes invalid during an operation, that is the voltage on VPP pin is below the
VPPH Voltage (9V), the VPP Status bit goes High (FSR<3>=1) and indeterminate results
can occur.
Once set High, the VPP Status bit can only be reset Low (FSR<3>=0) by a Clear Flag Status
Register command (CLFSR). If set High it should be reset before a new Program or Erase
command is issued, otherwise the new command will appear to fail.
6.5.6
Program Suspend Status bit
The bit 2 of the Flag Status register represents the Program Suspend Status bit, It indicates
that an Program operation has been suspended or is going to be suspended.
46/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Volatile and Non Volatile Registers
The bit is set (FSR<2>=1) within the Erase Suspend Latency time, that is as soon as the
Program/Erase Suspend command (PES) has been issued, therefore the device may still
complete the operation before entering the Suspend Mode.
The Program Suspend Status should be considered valid when the P/E Controller bit is high
(FSR<7>=1).
When a Program/Erase Resume command (PER) is issued the Program Suspend Status bit
returns Low (FSR<2>=0)
6.5.7
Protection Status bit
The bit 1 of the Flag Status Register represents the Protection Status bit. It indicates that an
Erase or Program operation has tried to modify the contents of a protected array sector, or
that a modify operation has tried to access to a locked OTP space. The Protection Status bit
is related to all possible protection violations as follows:
„ The sector is protected by Software Protection Mode 1 (SPM1) Lock registers,
„ The sector is protected by Software Protection Mode 2 (SPM2) Block Protect Bits
(standard SPI Status Register),
„ An attempt to program OTP when locked,
„ A Write Status Register command (WRSR) on STD SPI Status Register when locked by
the SRWD bit in conjunction with the Write Protect (W/VPP) signal (Hardware Protection
Mode).
Once set High, the Protection Status bit can only be reset Low (FSR<1>=0) by a Clear Flag
Status Register command (CLFSR). If set High it should be reset before a new command is
issued, otherwise the new command will appear to fail.
47/180
Protection modes
7
N25Q128 - 3 V
Protection modes
There are protocol-related and specific hardware and software protection modes. They are
described below.
7.1
SPI Protocol-related protections
This applies to all three protocols. The environments where non-volatile memory devices
are used can be very noisy. No SPI device can operate correctly in the presence of
excessive noise. To help combat this, the N25Q128 features the following data protection
mechanisms:
„
Power On Reset and an internal timer (tPUW) can provide protection against
inadvertent changes while the power supply is outside the operating specification.
„
Program, Erase, and Write Status Register instructions are checked to ensure the
instruction includes a number of clock pulses that is a multiple of a byte before they are
accepted for execution.
„
All instructions that modify data must be preceded by a Write Enable (WREN)
instruction to set the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit. This bit is returned to its reset state
by the following events (in Extended SPI protocol mode):
–
Power-up
–
Write Disable (WRDI) instruction completion
–
Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction completion
–
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction completion
–
Program OTP (POTP) instruction completion
–
Page Program (PP) instruction completion
–
Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction completion
–
Dual Input Extended Fast Program (DIEFP) instruction completion
–
Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction completion
–
Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP) instruction completion
–
Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction completion
–
Sector Erase (SE) instruction completion
–
Bulk Erase (BE) instruction completion
This bit is also returned to its reset state after all the analogous events in DIO-SPI and QIOSPI protocol modes.
7.2
Specific hardware and software protection
There are two software protected modes, SPM1 and SPM2, that can be combined to protect
the memory array as required. The SPM2 can be locked by hardware with the help of the W
input pin.
SPM1
The first software protected mode (SPM1) is managed by specific Lock Registers assigned
to each 64 Kbyte sector.
48/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Protection modes
The Lock Registers can be read and written using the Read Lock Register (RDLR) and
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instructions.
In each Lock Register two bits control the protection of each sector: the Write Lock bit and
the Lock Down bit.
„
Write Lock bit: The Write Lock bit determines whether the contents of the sector can be
modified (using the Write, Program, or Erase instructions). When the Write Lock bit is
set to '1', the sector is write protected - any operations that attempt to change the data
in the sector will fail. When the Write Lock bit is reset to '0', the sector is not write
protected by the Lock Register, and may be modified.
„
Lock Down bit: The Lock Down bit provides a mechanism for protecting software data
from simple hacking and malicious attack. When the Lock Down bit is set to '1', further
modification to the Write Lock and Lock Down bits cannot be performed. A powerup is
required before changes to these bits can be made. When the Lock Down bit is reset to
'0', the Write Lock and Lock Down bits can be changed.
The definition of the Lock Register bits is given in Table 9: Lock Register out.
SPM2
The second software protected mode (SPM2) uses the Block Protect bits (BP3, BP2, BP1,
BP0) and the Top/Bottom bit (TB bit) to allow part of the memory to be configured as readonly. See Section 16: Ordering information.
Table 8.
Software protection truth table (Sectors 0 to 255, 64 Kbyte granularity)
Sector Lock Register
Protection Status
Lock Down bit
Write Lock bit
0
0
Sector unprotected from Program/Erase/Write operations, protection status
reversible.
0
1
Sector protected from Program/Erase/Write operations, protection status
reversible.
1
0
Sector unprotected from Program/Erase/Write operations.
Sector protection status cannot be changed except by a power-up.
1
1
Sector protected from Program/Erase/Write operations.
Sector protection status cannot be changed except by a power-up.
As a second level of protection, the Write Protect signal (applied on the W/VPP pin) can
freeze the Status Register in a read-only mode. In this mode, the Block Protect bits (BP3,
BP2, BP1, BP0) and the Status Register Write Disable bit (SRWD) are protected.
49/180
Protection modes
Table 9.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Protected area sizes (TB bit = 0)
Status Register Content
Memory Content
TB bit BP3 Bit PB2 Bit BP1 Bit BP0 Bit
Protected Area
Unprotected Area
0
0
0
0
0
None
All sectors (sectors 0 to 255)
0
0
0
0
1
Upper 256th
(1/2 Mbit, sector 255)
Sectors 0 to 254
0
0
0
1
0
Upper 128th
(1 Mbit, 2 sectors: 254 to 255)
Sectors 0 to 253
0
0
0
1
1
Upper 64th
(2 Mbit, 4 sectors: 252 to 255)
Sectors 0 to 251
0
0
1
0
0
Upper 32nd
(4 Mbit, 8 sectors: 248 to 255)
Sectors 0 to 247
0
0
1
0
1
Upper 16th
(8 Mbit, 16 sectors: 240 to 255)
Sectors 0 to 239
0
0
1
1
0
Upper 8th
Sectors 0 to 223
(16 Mbit, 32 sectors: 224 to 255)
0
0
1
1
1
Upper quarter
Lower 3 quarters (sectors 0 to
(32 Mbit, 64 sectors: 193 to 255) 191)
0
1
0
0
0
Upper half
(64 Mbit, 128 sectors: 128 to
255)
Lower half (sectors 0 to 127)
0
1
0
0
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
0
1
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
0
1
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
1
0
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
1
0
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
1
1
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
0
1
1
1
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
50/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 10.
Protection modes
Protected area sizes (TB bit = 1)
Status Register Content
Memory Content
TB bit BP3 Bit PB2 Bit BP1 Bit BP0 Bit
Protected Area
Unprotected Area
1
0
0
0
0
None
All sectors (sectors 0 to 255)
1
0
0
0
1
Lower 256th
(1/2 Mbit, sector 0)
Sectors 1 to 255
1
0
0
1
0
Lower 128th
(1 Mbit, 2 sectors: 0 to 1)
Sectors 2 to 255
1
0
0
1
1
Lower 64th
(2 Mbit, 4 sectors: 0 to 3)
Sectors 4 to 255
1
0
1
0
0
Lower 32nd
(4 Mbit, 8 sectors: 0 to 7)
Sectors 8 to 255
1
0
1
0
1
Lower 16th
(8 Mbit, 16 sectors: 0 to 15)
Sectors 16 to 255
1
0
1
1
0
Lower 8th
(16 Mbit, 32 sectors: 0 to 31)
Sectors 33 to 255
1
0
1
1
1
Lower quarter
(32 Mbit, 64 sectors: 0 to 63)
Upper 3 quarters (sectors 64 to
255)
1
1
0
0
0
Lower half
(64 Mbit, 128 sectors: 0 to 127)
Upper half (sectors 128 to 255)
1
1
0
0
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
0
1
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
0
1
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
1
0
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
1
0
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
1
1
0
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
1
1
1
1
1
All sectors
(128 Mbit, 256 sectors)
None
The N25Q128 is available in the following architecture versions:
„
Bottom version, 64 KB uniform sectors plus 8 bottom boot sectors (each with 16
subsectors),
„
Top version, 64 KB uniform sectors plus 8 top boot sectors (each with 16 subsectors)
„
Uniform version, 64 KB uniform sectors without any boot sectors and subsectors.
51/180
Memory organization
8
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
The memory is organized as:
„
16,777,216 bytes (8 bits each)
„
256 sectors (64 Kbytes each)
„
In Bottom and Top versions: 8 bottom (top) 64 Kbytes boot sectors with 16 subsectors
(4 Kbytes) and 248 standard 64 KB sectors
„
65,536 pages (256 bytes each)
„
64 OTP bytes located outside the main memory array
Each page can be individually programmed (bits are programmed from 1 to 0). The device is
Sector or Bulk Erasable (bits are erased from 0 to 1) but not Page Erasable, Subsector
Erase is allowed on the 8 boot sectors (for devices with bottom or top architecture).
Figure 9.
Block diagram
HOLD
W/VPP
High Voltage
Generator
Control Logic
64 OTP bytes
S
C
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
I/O Shift Register
Address Register
and Counter
Status
Register
256 Byte
Data Buffer
Y Decoder
FFFFFFh
00000h
000FFh
256 bytes (page size)
X Decoder
AI13722a
52/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 11.
Memory organization (uniform) (page 1 of 8)
Sector
Address range
255
FF0000
FFFFFF
254
FE0000
FEFFFF
253
FD0000
FDFFFF
252
FC0000
FCFFFF
251
FB0000
FBFFFF
250
FA0000
FAFFFF
249
F90000
F9FFFF
248
F80000
F8FFFF
247
F70000
F7FFFF
246
F60000
F6FFFF
245
F50000
F5FFFF
244
F40000
F4FFFF
243
F30000
F3FFFF
242
F20000
F2FFFF
241
F10000
F1FFFF
240
F00000
F0FFFF
239
EF0000
EFFFFF
238
EE0000
EEFFFF
237
ED0000
EDFFFF
236
EC0000
ECFFFF
235
EB0000
EBFFFF
234
EA0000
EAFFFF
233
E90000
E9FFFF
232
E80000
E8FFFF
231
E70000
E7FFFF
230
E60000
E6FFFF
229
E50000
E5FFFF
228
E40000
E4FFFF
227
E30000
E3FFFF
226
E20000
E2FFFF
225
E10000
E1FFFF
224
E00000
E0FFFF
223
DF0000
DFFFFF
222
DE0000
DEFFFF
53/180
Memory organization
Table 11.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization (uniform) (page 2 of 8)
Sector
54/180
Address range
221
DD0000
DDFFFF
220
DC0000
DCFFFF
219
DB0000
DBFFFF
218
DA0000
DAFFFF
217
D90000
D9FFFF
216
D80000
D8FFFF
215
D70000
D7FFFF
214
D60000
D6FFFF
213
D50000
D5FFFF
212
D40000
D4FFFF
211
D30000
D3FFFF
210
D20000
D2FFFF
209
D10000
D1FFFF
208
D00000
D0FFFF
207
CF0000
CFFFFF
206
CE0000
CEFFFF
205
CD0000
CDFFFF
204
CC0000
CCFFFF
203
CB0000
CBFFFF
202
CA0000
CAFFFF
201
C90000
C9FFFF
200
C80000
C8FFFF
199
C70000
C7FFFF
198
C60000
C6FFFF
197
C50000
C5FFFF
196
C40000
C4FFFF
195
C30000
C3FFFF
194
C20000
C2FFFF
193
C10000
C1FFFF
192
C00000
C0FFFF
191
BF0000
BFFFFF
190
BE0000
BEFFFF
189
BD0000
BDFFFF
188
BC0000
BCFFFF
187
BB0000
BBFFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 11.
Memory organization (uniform) (page 3 of 8)
Sector
Address range
186
BA0000
BAFFFF
185
B90000
B9FFFF
184
B80000
B8FFFF
183
B70000
B7FFFF
182
B60000
B6FFFF
181
B50000
B5FFFF
180
B40000
B4FFFF
179
B30000
B3FFFF
178
B20000
B2FFFF
177
B10000
B1FFFF
176
B00000
B0FFFF
175
AF0000
AFFFFF
174
AE0000
AEFFFF
173
AD0000
ADFFFF
172
AC0000
ACFFFF
171
AB0000
ABFFFF
170
AA0000
AAFFFF
169
A90000
A9FFFF
168
A80000
A8FFFF
167
A70000
A7FFFF
166
A60000
A6FFFF
165
A50000
A5FFFF
164
A40000
A4FFFF
163
A30000
A3FFFF
162
A20000
A2FFFF
161
A10000
A1FFFF
160
A00000
A0FFFF
159
9F0000
9FFFFF
158
9E0000
9EFFFF
157
9D0000
9DFFFF
156
9C0000
9CFFFF
155
9B0000
9BFFFF
154
9A0000
9AFFFF
153
990000
99FFFF
152
980000
98FFFF
55/180
Memory organization
Table 11.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization (uniform) (page 4 of 8)
Sector
56/180
Address range
151
970000
97FFFF
150
960000
96FFFF
149
950000
95FFFF
148
940000
94FFFF
147
930000
93FFFF
146
920000
92FFFF
145
910000
91FFFF
144
900000
90FFFF
143
8F0000
8FFFFF
142
8E0000
8EFFFF
141
8D0000
8DFFFF
140
8C0000
8CFFFF
139
8B0000
8BFFFF
138
8A0000
8AFFFF
137
890000
89FFFF
136
880000
88FFFF
135
870000
87FFFF
134
860000
86FFFF
133
850000
85FFFF
132
840000
84FFFF
131
830000
83FFFF
130
820000
82FFFF
129
810000
81FFFF
128
800000
80FFFF
127
7F0000
7FFFFF
126
7E0000
7EFFFF
125
7D0000
7DFFFF
124
7C0000
7CFFFF
123
7B0000
7BFFFF
122
7A0000
7AFFFF
121
790000
79FFFF
120
780000
78FFFF
119
770000
77FFFF
118
760000
76FFFF
117
750000
75FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 11.
Memory organization (uniform) (page 5 of 8)
Sector
Address range
116
740000
74FFFF
115
730000
73FFFF
114
720000
72FFFF
113
710000
71FFFF
112
700000
70FFFF
111
6F0000
6FFFFF
110
6E0000
6EFFFF
109
6D0000
6DFFFF
108
6C0000
6CFFFF
107
6B0000
6BFFFF
106
6A0000
6AFFFF
105
690000
69FFFF
104
680000
68FFFF
103
670000
67FFFF
102
660000
66FFFF
101
650000
65FFFF
100
640000
64FFFF
99
630000
63FFFF
98
620000
62FFFF
97
610000
61FFFF
96
600000
60FFFF
95
5F0000
5FFFFF
94
5E0000
5EFFFF
93
5D0000
5DFFFF
92
5C0000
5CFFFF
91
5B0000
5BFFFF
90
5A0000
5AFFFF
89
590000
59FFFF
88
580000
58FFFF
87
570000
57FFFF
86
560000
56FFFF
85
550000
55FFFF
84
540000
54FFFF
83
530000
53FFFF
82
520000
52FFFF
57/180
Memory organization
Table 11.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization (uniform) (page 6 of 8)
Sector
58/180
Address range
81
510000
51FFFF
80
500000
50FFFF
79
4F0000
4FFFFF
78
4E0000
4EFFFF
77
4D0000
4DFFFF
76
4C0000
4CFFFF
75
4B0000
4BFFFF
74
4A0000
4AFFFF
73
490000
49FFFF
72
480000
48FFFF
71
470000
47FFFF
70
460000
46FFFF
69
450000
45FFFF
68
440000
44FFFF
67
430000
43FFFF
66
420000
42FFFF
65
410000
41FFFF
64
400000
40FFFF
63
3F0000
3FFFFF
62
3E0000
3EFFFF
61
3D0000
3DFFFF
60
3C0000
3CFFFF
59
3B0000
3BFFFF
58
3A0000
3AFFFF
57
390000
39FFFF
56
380000
38FFFF
55
370000
37FFFF
54
360000
36FFFF
53
350000
35FFFF
52
340000
34FFFF
51
330000
33FFFF
50
320000
32FFFF
49
310000
31FFFF
48
300000
30FFFF
47
2F0000
2FFFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 11.
Memory organization (uniform) (page 7 of 8)
Sector
Address range
46
2E0000
2EFFFF
45
2D0000
2DFFFF
44
2C0000
2CFFFF
43
2B0000
2BFFFF
42
2A0000
2AFFFF
41
290000
29FFFF
40
280000
28FFFF
39
270000
27FFFF
38
260000
26FFFF
37
250000
25FFFF
36
240000
24FFFF
35
230000
23FFFF
34
220000
22FFFF
33
210000
21FFFF
32
200000
20FFFF
31
1F0000
1FFFFF
30
1E0000
1EFFFF
29
1D0000
1DFFFF
28
1C0000
1CFFFF
27
1B0000
1BFFFF
26
1A0000
1AFFFF
25
190000
19FFFF
24
180000
18FFFF
23
170000
17FFFF
22
160000
16FFFF
21
150000
15FFFF
20
140000
14FFFF
19
130000
13FFFF
18
120000
12FFFF
17
110000
11FFFF
16
100000
10FFFF
15
F0000
FFFFF
14
E0000
EFFFF
13
D0000
DFFFF
12
C0000
CFFFF
59/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 11.
Memory organization (uniform) (page 8 of 8)
Sector
Address range
11
B0000
BFFFF
10
A0000
AFFFF
9
90000
9FFFF
8
80000
8FFFF
7
70000
7FFFF
6
60000
6FFFF
5
50000
5FFFF
4
40000
4FFFF
3
30000
3FFFF
2
20000
2FFFF
1
10000
1FFFF
0
0
FFFF
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 1 of 9)
Sector
60/180
Subsector
Address range
255
-
FF0000
FFFFFF
254
-
FE0000
FEFFFF
253
-
FD0000
FDFFFF
252
-
FC0000
FCFFFF
251
-
FB0000
FBFFFF
250
-
FA0000
FAFFFF
249
-
F90000
F9FFFF
248
-
F80000
F8FFFF
247
-
F70000
F7FFFF
246
-
F60000
F6FFFF
245
-
F50000
F5FFFF
244
-
F40000
F4FFFF
243
-
F30000
F3FFFF
242
-
F20000
F2FFFF
241
-
F10000
F1FFFF
240
-
F00000
F0FFFF
239
-
EF0000
EFFFFF
238
-
EE0000
EEFFFF
237
-
ED0000
EDFFFF
236
-
EC0000
ECFFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 2 of 9)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
235
-
EB0000
EBFFFF
234
-
EA0000
EAFFFF
233
-
E90000
E9FFFF
232
-
E80000
E8FFFF
231
-
E70000
E7FFFF
230
-
E60000
E6FFFF
229
-
E50000
E5FFFF
228
-
E40000
E4FFFF
227
-
E30000
E3FFFF
226
-
E20000
E2FFFF
225
-
E10000
E1FFFF
224
-
E00000
E0FFFF
223
-
DF0000
DFFFFF
222
-
DE0000
DEFFFF
221
-
DD0000
DDFFFF
220
-
DC0000
DCFFFF
219
-
DB0000
DBFFFF
218
-
DA0000
DAFFFF
217
-
D90000
D9FFFF
216
-
D80000
D8FFFF
215
-
D70000
D7FFFF
214
-
D60000
D6FFFF
213
-
D50000
D5FFFF
212
-
D40000
D4FFFF
211
-
D30000
D3FFFF
210
-
D20000
D2FFFF
209
-
D10000
D1FFFF
208
-
D00000
D0FFFF
207
-
CF0000
CFFFFF
206
-
CE0000
CEFFFF
205
-
CD0000
CDFFFF
204
-
CC0000
CCFFFF
203
-
CB0000
CBFFFF
202
-
CA0000
CAFFFF
201
-
C90000
C9FFFF
61/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 3 of 9)
Sector
62/180
Subsector
Address range
200
-
C80000
C8FFFF
199
-
C70000
C7FFFF
198
-
C60000
C6FFFF
197
-
C50000
C5FFFF
196
-
C40000
C4FFFF
195
-
C30000
C3FFFF
194
-
C20000
C2FFFF
193
-
C10000
C1FFFF
192
-
C00000
C0FFFF
191
-
BF0000
BFFFFF
190
-
BE0000
BEFFFF
189
-
BD0000
BDFFFF
188
-
BC0000
BCFFFF
187
-
BB0000
BBFFFF
186
-
BA0000
BAFFFF
185
-
B90000
B9FFFF
184
-
B80000
B8FFFF
183
-
B70000
B7FFFF
182
-
B60000
B6FFFF
181
-
B50000
B5FFFF
180
-
B40000
B4FFFF
179
-
B30000
B3FFFF
178
-
B20000
B2FFFF
177
-
B10000
B1FFFF
176
-
B00000
B0FFFF
175
-
AF0000
AFFFFF
174
-
AE0000
AEFFFF
173
-
AD0000
ADFFFF
172
-
AC0000
ACFFFF
171
-
AB0000
ABFFFF
170
-
AA0000
AAFFFF
169
-
A90000
A9FFFF
168
-
A80000
A8FFFF
167
-
A70000
A7FFFF
166
-
A60000
A6FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 4 of 9)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
165
-
A50000
A5FFFF
164
-
A40000
A4FFFF
163
-
A30000
A3FFFF
162
-
A20000
A2FFFF
161
-
A10000
A1FFFF
160
-
A00000
A0FFFF
159
-
9F0000
9FFFFF
158
-
9E0000
9EFFFF
157
-
9D0000
9DFFFF
156
-
9C0000
9CFFFF
155
-
9B0000
9BFFFF
154
-
9A0000
9AFFFF
153
-
990000
99FFFF
152
-
980000
98FFFF
151
-
970000
97FFFF
150
-
960000
96FFFF
149
-
950000
95FFFF
148
-
940000
94FFFF
147
-
930000
93FFFF
146
-
920000
92FFFF
145
-
910000
91FFFF
144
-
900000
90FFFF
143
-
8F0000
8FFFFF
142
-
8E0000
8EFFFF
141
-
8D0000
8DFFFF
140
-
8C0000
8CFFFF
139
-
8B0000
8BFFFF
138
-
8A0000
8AFFFF
137
-
890000
89FFFF
136
-
880000
88FFFF
135
-
870000
87FFFF
134
-
860000
86FFFF
133
-
850000
85FFFF
132
-
840000
84FFFF
131
-
830000
83FFFF
63/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 5 of 9)
Sector
64/180
Subsector
Address range
130
-
820000
82FFFF
129
-
810000
81FFFF
128
-
800000
80FFFF
127
-
7F0000
7FFFFF
126
-
7E0000
7EFFFF
125
-
7D0000
7DFFFF
124
-
7C0000
7CFFFF
123
-
7B0000
7BFFFF
122
-
7A0000
7AFFFF
121
-
790000
79FFFF
120
-
780000
78FFFF
119
-
770000
77FFFF
118
-
760000
76FFFF
117
-
750000
75FFFF
116
-
740000
74FFFF
115
-
730000
73FFFF
114
-
720000
72FFFF
113
-
710000
71FFFF
112
-
700000
70FFFF
111
-
6F0000
6FFFFF
110
-
6E0000
6EFFFF
109
-
6D0000
6DFFFF
108
-
6C0000
6CFFFF
107
-
6B0000
6BFFFF
106
-
6A0000
6AFFFF
105
-
690000
69FFFF
104
-
680000
68FFFF
103
-
670000
67FFFF
102
-
660000
66FFFF
101
-
650000
65FFFF
100
-
640000
64FFFF
99
-
630000
63FFFF
98
-
620000
62FFFF
97
-
610000
61FFFF
96
-
600000
60FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 6 of 9)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
95
-
5F0000
5FFFFF
94
-
5E0000
5EFFFF
93
-
5D0000
5DFFFF
92
-
5C0000
5CFFFF
91
-
5B0000
5BFFFF
90
-
5A0000
5AFFFF
89
-
590000
59FFFF
88
-
580000
58FFFF
87
-
570000
57FFFF
86
-
560000
56FFFF
85
-
550000
55FFFF
84
-
540000
54FFFF
83
-
530000
53FFFF
82
-
520000
52FFFF
81
-
510000
51FFFF
80
-
500000
50FFFF
79
-
4F0000
4FFFFF
78
-
4E0000
4EFFFF
77
-
4D0000
4DFFFF
76
-
4C0000
4CFFFF
75
-
4B0000
4BFFFF
74
-
4A0000
4AFFFF
73
-
490000
49FFFF
72
-
480000
48FFFF
71
-
470000
47FFFF
70
-
460000
46FFFF
69
-
450000
45FFFF
68
-
440000
44FFFF
67
-
430000
43FFFF
66
-
420000
42FFFF
65
-
410000
41FFFF
64
-
400000
40FFFF
63
-
3F0000
3FFFFF
62
-
3E0000
3EFFFF
61
-
3D0000
3DFFFF
65/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 7 of 9)
Sector
66/180
Subsector
Address range
60
-
3C0000
3CFFFF
59
-
3B0000
3BFFFF
58
-
3A0000
3AFFFF
57
-
390000
39FFFF
56
-
380000
38FFFF
55
-
370000
37FFFF
54
-
360000
36FFFF
53
-
350000
35FFFF
52
-
340000
34FFFF
51
-
330000
33FFFF
50
-
320000
32FFFF
49
-
310000
31FFFF
48
-
300000
30FFFF
47
-
2F0000
2FFFFF
46
-
2E0000
2EFFFF
45
-
2D0000
2DFFFF
44
-
2C0000
2CFFFF
43
-
2B0000
2BFFFF
42
-
2A0000
2AFFFF
41
-
290000
29FFFF
40
-
280000
28FFFF
39
-
270000
27FFFF
38
-
260000
26FFFF
37
-
250000
25FFFF
36
-
240000
24FFFF
35
-
230000
23FFFF
34
-
220000
22FFFF
33
-
210000
21FFFF
32
-
200000
20FFFF
31
-
1F0000
1FFFFF
30
-
1E0000
1EFFFF
29
-
1D0000
1DFFFF
28
-
1C0000
1CFFFF
27
-
1B0000
1BFFFF
26
-
1A0000
1AFFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 12.
Memory organization (bottom) (page 8 of 9)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
190000
19FFFF
24
-
180000
18FFFF
23
-
170000
17FFFF
22
-
160000
16FFFF
21
-
150000
15FFFF
20
-
140000
14FFFF
19
-
130000
13FFFF
18
-
120000
12FFFF
17
-
110000
11FFFF
16
-
100000
10FFFF
15
-
F0000
FFFFF
14
-
E0000
EFFFF
13
-
D0000
DFFFF
12
-
C0000
CFFFF
11
-
B0000
BFFFF
10
-
A0000
AFFFF
9
-
90000
9FFFF
8
-
80000
8FFFF
127
7F000
7FFFF
...
7
...
-
...
25
70FFF
111
6F000
6FFFF
...
6
...
70000
...
112
60FFF
95
5F000
5FFFF
...
5
...
60000
...
96
50FFF
79
4F000
4FFFF
...
4
...
50000
...
80
40FFF
63
3F000
3FFFF
...
3
...
40000
...
64
30FFF
47
2F000
2FFFF
...
2
32
20000
...
30000
...
48
20FFF
67/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization (bottom) (page 9 of 9)
Subsector
31
1F000
...
1
1FFFF
10FFF
15
F000
FFFF
...
0
FFF
Memory organization (top)
Subsector
127
FFF000
...
255
Address range
...
Sector
FFFFFF
...
Table 13.
0
...
10000
...
16
0
112
FF0000
FF0FFF
111
FEF000
FEFFFF
...
...
...
254
96
FE0000
FE0FFF
95
FDF000
FDFFFF
...
...
...
253
80
FD0000
FD0FFF
79
FCF000
FCFFFF
...
...
...
252
64
FC0000
FC0FFF
63
FBF000
FBFFFF
...
FB0000
FB0FFF
47
FAF000
FAFFFF
...
250
...
...
48
...
...
251
FA0FFF
31
F9F000
F9FFFF
...
...
FA0000
...
32
249
F90FFF
15
F8F000
F8FFFF
...
...
F90000
...
16
248
68/180
Address range
...
Sector
...
Table 12.
0
F80000
F80FFF
247
-
F70000
F7FFFF
246
-
F60000
F6FFFF
245
-
F50000
F5FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
244
-
F40000
F4FFFF
243
-
F30000
F3FFFF
242
-
F20000
F2FFFF
241
-
F10000
F1FFFF
240
-
F00000
F0FFFF
239
-
EF0000
EFFFFF
238
-
EE0000
EEFFFF
237
-
ED0000
EDFFFF
236
-
EC0000
ECFFFF
235
-
EB0000
EBFFFF
234
-
EA0000
EAFFFF
233
-
E90000
E9FFFF
232
-
E80000
E8FFFF
231
-
E70000
E7FFFF
230
-
E60000
E6FFFF
229
-
E50000
E5FFFF
228
-
E40000
E4FFFF
227
-
E30000
E3FFFF
226
-
E20000
E2FFFF
225
-
E10000
E1FFFF
224
-
E00000
E0FFFF
223
-
DF0000
DFFFFF
222
-
DE0000
DEFFFF
221
-
DD0000
DDFFFF
220
-
DC0000
DCFFFF
219
-
DB0000
DBFFFF
218
-
DA0000
DAFFFF
217
-
D90000
D9FFFF
216
-
D80000
D8FFFF
215
-
D70000
D7FFFF
214
-
D60000
D6FFFF
213
-
D50000
D5FFFF
212
-
D40000
D4FFFF
211
-
D30000
D3FFFF
210
-
D20000
D2FFFF
69/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
70/180
Subsector
Address range
209
-
D10000
D1FFFF
208
-
D00000
D0FFFF
207
-
CF0000
CFFFFF
206
-
CE0000
CEFFFF
205
-
CD0000
CDFFFF
204
-
CC0000
CCFFFF
203
-
CB0000
CBFFFF
202
-
CA0000
CAFFFF
201
-
C90000
C9FFFF
200
-
C80000
C8FFFF
199
-
C70000
C7FFFF
198
-
C60000
C6FFFF
197
-
C50000
C5FFFF
196
-
C40000
C4FFFF
195
-
C30000
C3FFFF
194
-
C20000
C2FFFF
193
-
C10000
C1FFFF
192
-
C00000
C0FFFF
191
-
BF0000
BFFFFF
190
-
BE0000
BEFFFF
189
-
BD0000
BDFFFF
188
-
BC0000
BCFFFF
187
-
BB0000
BBFFFF
186
-
BA0000
BAFFFF
185
-
B90000
B9FFFF
184
-
B80000
B8FFFF
183
-
B70000
B7FFFF
182
-
B60000
B6FFFF
181
-
B50000
B5FFFF
180
-
B40000
B4FFFF
179
-
B30000
B3FFFF
178
-
B20000
B2FFFF
177
-
B10000
B1FFFF
176
-
B00000
B0FFFF
175
-
AF0000
AFFFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
174
-
AE0000
AEFFFF
173
-
AD0000
ADFFFF
172
-
AC0000
ACFFFF
171
-
AB0000
ABFFFF
170
-
AA0000
AAFFFF
169
-
A90000
A9FFFF
168
-
A80000
A8FFFF
167
-
A70000
A7FFFF
166
-
A60000
A6FFFF
165
-
A50000
A5FFFF
164
-
A40000
A4FFFF
163
-
A30000
A3FFFF
162
-
A20000
A2FFFF
161
-
A10000
A1FFFF
160
-
A00000
A0FFFF
159
-
9F0000
9FFFFF
158
-
9E0000
9EFFFF
157
-
9D0000
9DFFFF
156
-
9C0000
9CFFFF
155
-
9B0000
9BFFFF
154
-
9A0000
9AFFFF
153
-
990000
99FFFF
152
-
980000
98FFFF
151
-
970000
97FFFF
150
-
960000
96FFFF
149
-
950000
95FFFF
148
-
940000
94FFFF
147
-
930000
93FFFF
146
-
920000
92FFFF
145
-
910000
91FFFF
144
-
900000
90FFFF
143
-
8F0000
8FFFFF
142
-
8E0000
8EFFFF
141
-
8D0000
8DFFFF
140
-
8C0000
8CFFFF
71/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
72/180
Subsector
Address range
139
-
8B0000
8BFFFF
138
-
8A0000
8AFFFF
137
-
890000
89FFFF
136
-
880000
88FFFF
135
-
870000
87FFFF
134
-
860000
86FFFF
133
-
850000
85FFFF
132
-
840000
84FFFF
131
-
830000
83FFFF
130
-
820000
82FFFF
129
-
810000
81FFFF
128
-
800000
80FFFF
127
-
7F0000
7FFFFF
126
-
7E0000
7EFFFF
125
-
7D0000
7DFFFF
124
-
7C0000
7CFFFF
123
-
7B0000
7BFFFF
122
-
7A0000
7AFFFF
121
-
790000
79FFFF
120
-
780000
78FFFF
119
-
770000
77FFFF
118
-
760000
76FFFF
117
-
750000
75FFFF
116
-
740000
74FFFF
115
-
730000
73FFFF
114
-
720000
72FFFF
113
-
710000
71FFFF
112
-
700000
70FFFF
111
-
6F0000
6FFFFF
110
-
6E0000
6EFFFF
109
-
6D0000
6DFFFF
108
-
6C0000
6CFFFF
107
-
6B0000
6BFFFF
106
-
6A0000
6AFFFF
105
-
690000
69FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
104
-
680000
68FFFF
103
-
670000
67FFFF
102
-
660000
66FFFF
101
-
650000
65FFFF
100
-
640000
64FFFF
99
-
630000
63FFFF
98
-
620000
62FFFF
97
-
610000
61FFFF
96
-
600000
60FFFF
95
-
5F0000
5FFFFF
94
-
5E0000
5EFFFF
93
-
5D0000
5DFFFF
92
-
5C0000
5CFFFF
91
-
5B0000
5BFFFF
90
-
5A0000
5AFFFF
89
-
590000
59FFFF
88
-
580000
58FFFF
87
-
570000
57FFFF
86
-
560000
56FFFF
85
-
550000
55FFFF
84
-
540000
54FFFF
83
-
530000
53FFFF
82
-
520000
52FFFF
81
-
510000
51FFFF
80
-
500000
50FFFF
79
-
4F0000
4FFFFF
78
-
4E0000
4EFFFF
77
-
4D0000
4DFFFF
76
-
4C0000
4CFFFF
75
-
4B0000
4BFFFF
74
-
4A0000
4AFFFF
73
-
490000
49FFFF
72
-
480000
48FFFF
71
-
470000
47FFFF
70
-
460000
46FFFF
73/180
Memory organization
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
74/180
Subsector
Address range
69
-
450000
45FFFF
68
-
440000
44FFFF
67
-
430000
43FFFF
66
-
420000
42FFFF
65
-
410000
41FFFF
64
-
400000
40FFFF
63
-
3F0000
3FFFFF
62
-
3E0000
3EFFFF
61
-
3D0000
3DFFFF
60
-
3C0000
3CFFFF
59
-
3B0000
3BFFFF
58
-
3A0000
3AFFFF
57
-
390000
39FFFF
56
-
380000
38FFFF
55
-
370000
37FFFF
54
-
360000
36FFFF
53
-
350000
35FFFF
52
-
340000
34FFFF
51
-
330000
33FFFF
50
-
320000
32FFFF
49
-
310000
31FFFF
48
-
300000
30FFFF
47
-
2F0000
2FFFFF
46
-
2E0000
2EFFFF
45
-
2D0000
2DFFFF
44
-
2C0000
2CFFFF
43
-
2B0000
2BFFFF
42
-
2A0000
2AFFFF
41
-
290000
29FFFF
40
-
280000
28FFFF
39
-
270000
27FFFF
38
-
260000
26FFFF
37
-
250000
25FFFF
36
-
240000
24FFFF
35
-
230000
23FFFF
N25Q128 - 3 V
Memory organization
Table 13.
Memory organization (top)
Sector
Subsector
Address range
34
-
220000
22FFFF
33
-
210000
21FFFF
32
-
200000
20FFFF
31
-
1F0000
1FFFFF
30
-
1E0000
1EFFFF
29
-
1D0000
1DFFFF
28
-
1C0000
1CFFFF
27
-
1B0000
1BFFFF
26
-
1A0000
1AFFFF
25
-
190000
19FFFF
24
-
180000
18FFFF
23
-
170000
17FFFF
22
-
160000
16FFFF
21
-
150000
15FFFF
20
-
140000
14FFFF
19
-
130000
13FFFF
18
-
120000
12FFFF
17
-
110000
11FFFF
16
-
100000
10FFFF
15
-
F0000
FFFFF
14
-
E0000
EFFFF
13
-
D0000
DFFFF
12
-
C0000
CFFFF
11
-
B0000
BFFFF
10
-
A0000
AFFFF
9
-
90000
9FFFF
8
-
80000
8FFFF
7
-
70000
7FFFF
6
-
60000
6FFFF
5
-
50000
5FFFF
4
-
40000
4FFFF
3
-
30000
3FFFF
2
-
20000
2FFFF
1
-
10000
1FFFF
0
-
0
FFFF
75/180
Instructions
9
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
The device can work in three different protocols: Extended SPI, DIO-SPI and QIO-SPI.
Each protocol has a dedicated instruction set, and each instruction set features the same
functionality:
„
Read, program and erase the memory and the 64 byte OTP area,
„
Suspend and resume the program or erase operations,
„
Read and modify all the registers and to read the device ID: please note that in this
case there is a small functionality difference among the single and the multiple I/O read
ID instructions. See Section 9.2.1: Multiple I/O Read Identification protocol and
Section 9.3.1: Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID).
The application can choose in every time of the device life which protocol to use by setting
the dedicated bits either in the Non Volatile Configuration Register or the Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register.
Note:
In multiple SPI protocols, all instructions, addresses, and data are parallel on two lines (DIOSPI protocol) or four lines (QIO-SPI protocol).
All instructions, addresses and data are shifted in and out of the device, most significant bit
first.
Serial Data input(s) is (are) sampled on the first rising edge of Serial Clock (C) after Chip
Select (S) is driven Low. Then, the one-byte instruction code must be shifted in to the
device, most significant bit first, on Serial Data input(s), each bit being latched on the rising
edges of Serial Clock (C). Instruction code is shifted into the device just on DQ0 in Extended
SPI protocol, on DQ0 and DQ1 in DIO-SPI protocol and on DQ0, DQ1, DQ2, and DQ3 in
QIO-SPI protocol.
In standard mode every instruction sequence starts with a one-byte instruction code.
Depending on the instruction, this might be followed by address bytes, or by data bytes, or
by both or none.
In XIP modes only read operation and exit XIP mode can be performed, and to read the
memory content no instructions code are needed: the device directly receives addresses
and after a configurable number of dummy clock cycle it outputs the required data.
9.1
Extended SPI Instructions
In Extended SPI protocol instruction set the instruction code is always shifted into the device
just on DQ0 pin, while depending on the instruction addresses and input/output data can run
on single, two or four wires.
In the case of a Read Instructions Data Bytes (READ), Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed
(FAST_READ), Dual Output Fast Read (DOFR), Dual Input/Output Fast Read (DIOFR),
Quad Output Fast Read (QOFR), Quad Input/Output Fast Read (QIOFR), Read OTP
(ROTP), Read Lock Registers (RDLR), Read Status Register (RDSR), Read Flag Status
Register (RFSR), Read NV Configuration Register (RDNVCR), Read Volatile Configuration
Register (RDVCR), Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) and Read
Identification (RDID) instruction, the shifted-in instruction sequence is followed by a data-out
sequence. Chip Select (S) can be driven High after any bit of the data-out sequence is being
shifted out.
76/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
In the case of a Page Program (PP), Program OTP (POTP), Dual Input Fast Program
(DIFP), Dual Input Extended Fast Program (DIEFP), Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP),
Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP), Subsector Erase (SSE), Sector Erase (SE),
Bulk Erase (BE), Write Status Register (WRSR), Clear Flag Status Register (CLFSR), Write
to Lock Register (WRLR), Write Configuration Register (WRVCR), Write Enhanced
Configuration Register (WRVECR), Write NV Configuration Register (WRNVCR), Write
Enable (WREN) or Write Disable (WRDI) instruction, Chip Select (S) must be driven High
exactly at a byte boundary, otherwise the instruction is rejected, and is not executed. That
is, Chip Select (S) must driven High when the number of clock pulses after Chip Select (S)
being driven Low is an exact multiple of eight.
All attempts to access the memory array are ignored during:
–
Write Status Register cycle
–
Write Non Volatile Configuration Register
–
Program cycle
–
Erase cycle
The following continue unaffected, with one exception:
–
Internal Write Status Register cycle,
–
Write Non Volatile Configuration Register,
–
Program cycle,
–
Erase cycle
The only exception is the Program/Erase Suspend instruction (PES), that can be used to
pause all the program and the erase cycles except for:
–
Program OTP (POTP),
–
Bulk Erase,
–
Write Non Volatile Configuration Register.
The suspended program or erase cycle can be resumed by the Program/Erase Resume
instruction (PER). During the program/erase cycles, the polling instructions (both on the
Status register and on the Flag Status register) are also accepted to allow the application to
check the end of the internal modify cycles.
Note:
These polling instructions don't affect the internal cycles performing.
77/180
Instructions
Table 14.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instruction set: extended SPI protocol (page 1 of 2)
Instruction
Description
One-byte
Instruction
Code (BIN)
One-byte
Dummy
Instruction Address
clock
Code (HEX) bytes
cycle
RDID
Read Identification
1001 111x
9Eh / 9Fh
0
0
READ
Read Data Bytes
0000 0011
03h
3
0
Data
bytes
1 to 20
1 to ∞
(1)
1 to ∞
FAST_READ Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed
0000 1011
0Bh
3
8
DOFR
Dual Output Fast Read
0011 1011
3Bh
3
8 (1)
1 to ∞
DIOFR
Dual Input/Output Fast Read
1011 1011
BB
3
8 (1)
1 to ∞
3
(1)
1 to ∞
QOFR
Quad Output Fast Read
0110 1011
6Bh
8
(1
1 to ∞
QIOFR
Quad Input/Output Fast Read
1110 1011
EBh
3
10
ROTP
Read OTP (Read of OTP area)
0100 1011
4Bh
3
8 (1)
1 to 65
WREN
Write Enable
0000 0110
06h
0
0
0
WRDI
Write Disable
0000 0100
04h
0
0
0
PP
Page Program
0000 0010
02h
3
0
1 to 256
DIFP
Dual Input Fast Program
1010 0010
A2h
3
0
1 to 256
DIEFP
Dual Input Extended Fast Program
1101 0010
D2h
3
0
1 to 256
QIFP
Quad Input Fast Program
0011 0010
32h
3
0
1 to 256
QIEFP
Quad Input Extended Fast Program
0001 0010
12h
3
0
1 to 256
POTP
Program OTP (Program of OTP area)
0100 0010
42h
3
0
1 to 65
SSE (2)
SubSector Erase
0010 0000
20h
3
0
0
SE
Sector Erase
1101 1000
D8h
3
0
0
BE
Bulk Erase
1100 0111
C7h
0
0
0
PER
Program/Erase Resume
0111 1010
7Ah
0
0
0
PES
Program/Erase Suspend
0111 0101
75h
0
0
0
RDSR
Read Status Register
0000 0101
05h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRSR
Write Status Register
0000 0001
01h
0
0
1
RDLR
Read Lock Register
1110 1000
E8h
3
0
1 to ∞
WRLR
Write to Lock Register
1110 0101
E5h
3
0
1
RFSR
Read Flag Status Register
0111 0000
70h
0
0
1 to ∞
CLFSR
Clear Flag Status Register
0101 0000
50h
0
0
0
RDNVCR
Read NV Configuration Register
1011 0101
B5h
0
0
2
WRNVCR
Write NV Configuration Register
1011 0001
B1h
0
0
2
RDVCR
Read Volatile Configuration Register
1000 0101
85h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVCR
Write Volatile Configuration Register
1000 0001
81h
0
0
1
78/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 14.
Instructions
Instruction set: extended SPI protocol (page 2 of 2)
Instruction
Description
One-byte
Instruction
Code (BIN)
One-byte
Dummy
Instruction Address
clock
Code (HEX) bytes
cycle
Data
bytes
RDVECR
Read Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register
0110 0101
65h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVECR
Write Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register
0110 0001
61h
0
0
1
1) The Number of dummy clock cycles is configurable by user
2) Subsector erase instruction is only available in Bottom or Top parts
9.1.1
Read Identification (RDID)
The Read Identification (RDID) instruction allows to read the device identification data:
–
Manufacturer identification (1 byte)
–
Device identification (2 bytes)
–
A Unique ID code (UID) (17 bytes, of which 14 factory programmed upon
customer request).
The manufacturer identification is assigned by JEDEC, and has the value 20h. The device
identification is assigned by the device manufacturer, and indicates the memory type in the
first byte (BAh), and the memory capacity of the device in the second byte (18h). The UID is
composed by 17 read only bytes, containing the length of the following data in the first byte
(set to 10h), 2 bytes of Extended Device ID (EDID) to identify the specific device
configuration (Top, Bottom or uniform architecture, Hold or Reset functionality), and 14
bytes of the optional Customized Factory Data (CFD) content. The CFD bytes can be
factory programmed with customers data upon their demand. If the customers do not make
requests, the devices are shipped with all the CFD bytes programmed to zero (00h).
Any Read Identification (RDID) instruction while an Erase or Program cycle is in progress, is
not decoded, and has no effect on the cycle that is in progress.
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. Then, the 8-bit instruction code
for the instruction is shifted in. After this, the 24-bit device identification, stored in the
memory, the 17 bytes of UID content will be shifted out on Serial Data output (DQ1). Each
bit is shifted out during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The instruction sequence is shown in Figure 10.
The Read Identification (RDID) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High at
any time during data output.
79/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
When Chip Select (S) is driven High, the device is put in the Standby Power mode. Once in
the Standby Power mode, the device waits to be selected, so that it can receive, decode and
execute instructions.
Table 15.
Read Identification data-out sequence
Manufacturer
Identification
Device identification
20h
Table 16.
Bit 7
UID
Memory type
Memory capacity
EDID+CFD length
EDID
CFD
BAh
18h
10h
2 bytes
14 bytes
Extended Device ID table (first byte)
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Reserved Reserved Reserved
VCR XIP bit setting:
0 = required,
1 = not required
Bit 3
Bit 2
Hold/Reset function:
0 = HOLD,
1 = Reset
Bit 1
Addressing:
0 = by Byte,
Bit 0
Architecture:
00 = Uniform,
01 = Bottom,
11 = Top
Figure 10. Read identification instruction and data-out sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
28 29 30 31
C
Instruction
DQ0
Manufacturer identification
UID
Device identification
High Impedance
DQ1
15 14 13
MSB
MSB
3
2
1
0
MSB
AI06809d
9.1.2
Read Data Bytes (READ)
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Read
Data Bytes (READ) instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0), each bit being
latched-in during the rising edge of Serial Clock (C). Then the memory contents, at that
address, is shifted out on Serial Data output (DQ1), each bit being shifted out, at a
maximum frequency fR, during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The first byte addressed can be at any location. The address is automatically incremented
to the next higher address after each byte of data is shifted out. The whole memory can,
therefore, be read with a single Read Data Bytes (READ) instruction. When the highest
address is reached, the address counter rolls over to 000000h, allowing the read sequence
to be continued indefinitely.
The Read Data Bytes (READ) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High. Chip
Select (S) can be driven High at any time during data output. Any Read Data Bytes (READ)
80/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
instruction, while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in progress, is rejected without having
any effects on the cycle that is in progress.
Figure 11.
Read Data Bytes instruction and data-out sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
C
Instruction
24-bit address (1)
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
MSB
Data out 1
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
4
3
Data out 2
2
1
0
7
MSB
AI13736b
9.1.3
Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ)
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Read
Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ) instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23A0) and a dummy byte, each bit being latched-in during the rising edge of Serial Clock (C).
Then the memory contents, at that address, are shifted out on Serial Data output (DQ1) at a
maximum frequency fC, during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The first byte addressed can be at any location. The address is automatically incremented
to the next higher address after each byte of data is shifted out. The whole memory can,
therefore, be read with a single Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ)
instruction. When the highest address is reached, the address counter rolls over to
000000h, allowing the read sequence to be continued indefinitely.
The Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ) instruction is terminated by driving
Chip Select (S) High. Chip Select (S) can be driven High at any time during data output. Any
Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed (FAST_READ) instruction, while an Erase, Program or
Write cycle is in progress, is rejected without having any effects on the cycle that is in
progress.
81/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 12. Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed instruction and data-out sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31
C
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
High Impedance
DQ1
S
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
C
Dummy cycles
DQ0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT 2
DATA OUT 1
DQ1
7
6
5
4
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
Read_Data_Bytes_Fast_Speed
9.1.4
Dual Output Fast Read (DOFR)
The Dual Output Fast Read (DOFR) instruction is very similar to the Read Data Bytes at
Higher Speed (FAST_READ) instruction, except that the data are shifted out on two pins
(pin DQ0 and pin DQ1) instead of only one. Outputting the data on two pins instead of one
doubles the data transfer bandwidth compared to the Read Data Bytes at Higher Speed
(FAST_READ) instruction.
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Dual
Output Fast Read instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) and a dummy byte,
each bit being latched-in during the rising edge of Serial Clock (C). Then the memory
contents, at that address, are shifted out on DQ0 and DQ1 at a maximum frequency Fc,
during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The first byte addressed can be at any location. The address is automatically incremented
to the next higher address after each byte of data is shifted out on DQ0 and DQ1. The whole
memory can, therefore, be read with a single Dual Output Fast Read (DOFR) instruction.
When the highest address is reached, the address counter rolls over to 00 0000h, so that
the read sequence can be continued indefinitely.
82/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 13. Dual Output Fast Read instruction sequence
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
Mode 2
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
DQ1
28 29 30 31
3
2
1
0
High Impedance
S
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
C
Dummy cycles
DQ0
6
4
2
0
DATA OUT 1
DQ1
7
MSB
5
3
1
6
4
2
0
DATA OUT 2
7
MSB
5
3
1
6
4
2
0
DATA OUT 3
7
MSB
5
3
1
6
4
2
0
DATA OUT n
7
MSB
5
3
1
MSB
Dual_Output_Data_Fast_Read
9.1.5
Dual I/O Fast Read
The Dual I/O Fast Read (DIOFR) instruction is very similar to the Dual Output Fast Read
(DOFR), except that the address bits are shifted in on two pins (pin DQ0 and pin DQ1)
instead of only one.
83/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 14. Dual I/O Fast Read instruction sequence
S
Mode 3
C
1
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
8
Mode 0
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Address
Dummy Cycles
S
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
C
IO switches from Input to Output
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
DQ0
DQ1
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 4
Dual_IO_Fast_Read
9.1.6
Quad Output Fast Read
The Quad Output Fast Read (QOFR) instruction is very similar to the Dual Output Fast
Read (DOFR) instruction, except that the data are shifted out on four pins (pin DQ0, pin
DQ1, pin W/VPP/DQ2 and pin HOLD/DQ3 (1) instead of only two. Outputting the data on
four pins instead of one doubles the data transfer bandwidth compared to the Dual Output
Fast Read (DOFR) instruction.
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Quad
Output Fast Read instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) and a dummy byte,
each bit being latched-in during the rising edge of Serial Clock (C). Then the memory
contents, at that address, are shifted out on pin DQ0, pin DQ1, pin W/VPP/DQ2 and pin
HOLD/DQ3 (1) at a maximum frequency fC, during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The instruction sequence is shown in Figure 15.
The first byte addressed can be at any location. The address is automatically incremented
to the next higher address after each byte of data is shifted out on pin DQ0, pin DQ1, pin
W/VPP/DQ2 and pin HOLD/DQ3 (1). The whole memory can, therefore, be read with a
single Quad Output Fast Read (QOFR) instruction.
When the highest address is reached, the address counter rolls over to 00 0000h, so that
the read sequence can be continued indefinitely.
84/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Note:
Instructions
Reset functionality is available instead of Hold in devices with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
Figure 15. Quad Input/Output Fast Read instruction sequence
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Mode 0
Instruction
DQ2
IO switches from Input to Output
Address
0
DQ0
DQ1
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
4
0
4
0
4
5
1
5
1
5
6
2
6
2
6
7
3
7
3
7
Don’t Care
Don’t Care
DQ3
‘1’
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Byte 1 Byte 2
Quad_Output_Fast_Read
9.1.7
Quad I/O Fast Read
The Quad I/O Fast Read (QIOFR) instruction is very similar to the Quad Output Fast Read
(QOFR), except that the address bits are shifted in on four pins (pin DQ0, pin DQ1, pin
W/VPP/DQ2 and pin HOLD/DQ3 (1)) instead of only one.
Note:
Reset functionality is available instead of Hold in devices with a dedicated part number. See
Section 16: Ordering information.
85/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 16. Quad Input/ Output Fast Read instruction sequence
S
Mode 3
C
1
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
Don’t Care
Don’t Care
DQ3
‘1’
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Byte 1 Byte 2
Quad_IO_Fast_Read
9.1.8
Read OTP (ROTP)
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Read
OTP (ROTP) instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23- A0) and a dummy byte. Each
bit is latched in on the rising edge of Serial Clock (C).
Then the memory contents at that address are shifted out on Serial Data output (DQ1).
Each bit is shifted out at the maximum frequency, fCmax, on the falling edge of Serial Clock
(C). The instruction sequence is shown in Figure 17.
The address is automatically incremented to the next higher address after each byte of data
is shifted out.
There is no rollover mechanism with the Read OTP (ROTP) instruction. This means that the
Read OTP (ROTP) instruction must be sent with a maximum of 65 bytes to read. All other
bytes outside the OTP area are “Don’t Care.”
The Read OTP (ROTP) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High. Chip
Select (S) can be driven High at any time during data output. Any Read OTP (ROTP)
instruction issued while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in progress, is rejected without
having any effect on the cycle that is in progress.
86/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 17. Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31
C
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
High Impedance
DQ1
S
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
C
Dummy cycles
DQ0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA OUT n
DATA OUT 1
7
DQ1
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
Read_OTP
9.1.9
Write Enable (WREN)
The Write Enable (WREN) instruction (Figure 8) sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
The Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit must be set prior to every Program, Erase or Write
instructions:
Page Program (PP), Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP), Dual Input Extended Fast Program
(DIEFP), Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP), Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP),
Program OTP (POTP), Write to Lock Register (WRLR), Subsector Erase (SSE), Sector
Erase (SE), Bulk Erase (BE), Write Status Register (WRSR), Write Configuration Register
(WRCR), Write Enhanced Configuration Register (WRECR) and Write NV Configuration
Register (WRNVCR) instruction.
The Write Enable (WREN) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, sending the
instruction code, and then driving Chip Select (S) High.
When the Fast POR feature is selected (Non Volatile Configuration Register bit 5) after the
first Write Enable instruction, the device enters in a latency time (~500 us), necessary to
internally complete the POR sequence with the modify algorithms. (See Section 11.1: Fast
POR.) During the POR latency time all the instructions are ignored with the exception of the
87/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
polling instructions (to check if the internal cycle is finished by mean of the WIP bit of the
Status Register or of the Program/Erase controller bit of the Flag Status register): to verify if
the POR sequence is completed is possible to check the WIP bit in the Status Register or
the Program/Erase Controller bit in the Flag Status Register, please note that the
Program/Erase Controller bit in the Flag status register has the reverse logical polarity with
respect to the Status Register WIP bit.
At the end of the POR sequence the WEL bit is low, so the next modify instruction can be
accepted.
Figure 18. Write Enable instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
C
Instruction
DQ0
High Impedance
DQ1
AI13731
9.1.10
Write Disable (WRDI)
The Write Disable (WRDI) instruction (Figure 9) resets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
The Write Disable (WRDI) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, sending the
instruction code, and then driving Chip Select (S) High.
88/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
The Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset under the following conditions:
„
Power-up
„
Write Disable (WRDI) instruction completion
„
Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction completion
„
Write lo Lock Register (WRLR) instruction completion
„
Write Non Volatile Configuration Register (WRNVCR) instruction completion
„
Write Volatile Configuration Register (WRVCR) instruction completion
„
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (WRVECR) instruction completion
„
Page Program (PP) instruction completion
„
Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction completion
„
Dual Input Extended Fast Program (DIEFP) instruction completion
„
Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction completion
„
Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP) instruction completion
„
Program OTP (POTP) instruction completion
„
Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction completion
„
Sector Erase (SE) instruction completion
„
Bulk Erase (BE) instruction completion
Figure 19. Write Disable instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
C
Instruction
DQ0
High Impedance
DQ1
AI13732
9.1.11
Page Program (PP)
The Page Program (PP) instruction allows bytes to be programmed in the memory
(changing bits from 1 to 0). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction
must previously have been executed. After the Write Enable (WREN) instruction has been
decoded, the device sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL).
The Page Program (PP) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed by
the instruction code, three address bytes and at least one data byte on Serial Data input
(DQ0). If the 8 least significant address bits (A7-A0) are not all zero, all transmitted data that
goes beyond the end of the current page are programmed from the start address of the
89/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
same page (from the address whose 8 least significant bits (A7-A0) are all zero). Chip
Select (S) must be driven Low for the entire duration of the sequence.
If more than 256 bytes are sent to the device, previously latched data are discarded and the
last 256 data bytes are guaranteed to be programmed correctly within the same page. If less
than 256 data bytes are sent to device, they are correctly programmed at the requested
addresses without having any effects on the other bytes of the same page.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the Page Program (PP) instruction to
program all consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence versus using several Page
Program (PP) sequences with each containing only a few bytes. See Table 32.: AC
Characteristics.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last data byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Page Program (PP) instruction is not executed.
As soon as Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Page Program cycle (whose
duration is top) is initiated. While the Page Program cycle is in progress, the Status Register
and the Flag Status Register may be read to check if the internal modify cycle is finished. At
some unspecified time before the cycle is completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is
reset.
A Page Program (PP) instruction applied to a page which is protected by the Block Protect
(BP3,BP2, BP1, BP0 and TB) bits is not executed.
Page Program cycle can be paused by mean of Program/Erase Suspend (PES) instruction
and resumed by mean of Program/Erase Resume (PER) instruction.
90/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 20. Page Program instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
9 10
C
Instruction
24-bit address (1)
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
Data byte 1
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
MSB
2078
2079
2077
2076
2075
2074
2073
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
2072
S
1
0
C
Data byte 2
DQ0
7
6
MSB
5
4
3
2
Data byte 3
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
MSB
2
Data byte 256
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
MSB
AI13739b
9.1.12
Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP)
The Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction is very similar to the Page Program (PP)
instruction, except that the data are entered on two pins (pin DQ0 and pin DQ1) instead of
only one. Inputting the data on two pins instead of one doubles the data transfer bandwidth
compared to the Page Program (PP) instruction.
The Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low,
followed by the instruction code, three address bytes and at least one data byte on Serial
Data input (DQ0).
If the 8 least significant address bits (A7-A0) are not all zero, all transmitted data that goes
beyond the end of the current page are programmed from the start address of the same
page (from the address whose 8 least significant bits (A7-A0) are all zero). Chip Select (S)
must be driven Low for the entire duration of the sequence.
If more than 256 bytes are sent to the device, previously latched data are discarded and the
last 256 data bytes are guaranteed to be programmed correctly within the same page. If less
than 256 data bytes are sent to device, they are correctly programmed at the requested
addresses without having any effects on the other bytes in the same page.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP)
instruction to program all consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather to using
91/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
several Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) sequences each containing only a few bytes. See
Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last data byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction is not executed.
As soon as Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Page Program cycle (whose
duration is top) is initiated. While the Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) cycle is in progress,
the Status Register and the Flag Status Register may be read to check if the internal modify
cycle is finished. At some unspecified time before the cycle is completed, the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) bit is reset.
A Dual Input Fast Program (DIFP) instruction applied to a page that is protected by the
Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0 and TB) bits is not executed.
Dual Input Fast Program cycle can be paused by mean of Program/Erase Suspend (PES)
instruction and resumed by mean of Program/Erase Resume (PER) instruction.
Figure 21. Dual Input Fast Program instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31
C
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
High Impedance
DQ1
S
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
C
DQ0
6
4
2
0
DATA IN 1
DQ1
7
MSB
5
3
6
4
2
0
DATA IN 2
1
7
MSB
5
3
6
4
2
0
6
DATA IN 3
1
7
MSB
5
3
4
2
0
6
DATA IN 4
1
7
MSB
5
3
4
2
0
DATA IN 5
1
7
MSB
5
3
6
4
2
0
DATA IN 256
1
7
5
3
1
MSB
AI14229
92/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
9.1.13
Instructions
Dual Input Extended Fast Program
The Dual Input Extended Fast Program (DIEFP) instruction is very similar to the Dual Input
Fast Program (DIFP), except that the address bits are shifted in on two pins (pin DQ0 and
pin DQ1) instead of only one.
Figure 22. Dual Input Extended Fast Program instruction sequence
S
Mode 3
C
1
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
Mode 0
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Address
Dummy Cycles
S
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
C
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
Data In 1
DQ1
7
5
3
MSB
4
2
0
6
Data In 2
1
7
5
3
1
MSB
4
2
0
6
5
3
MSB
1
2
0
6
7
5
3
MSB
1
4
2
0
Data In 256
Data In 4
Data In 3
7
4
7
5
3
1
MSB
Dual_Input_Extended_Fast_Program
9.1.14
Quad Input Fast Program
The Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction is very similar to the Dual Input Fast
Program (DIFP) instruction, except that the data are entered on four pins (pin DQ0, pin
DQ1, pin W/VPP/DQ2 and pin HOLD/ (DQ3) instead of only two. Inputting the data on four
pins instead of two doubles the data transfer bandwidth compared to the Dual Input Fast
Program (DIFP) instruction.
The Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low,
followed by the instruction code, three address bytes and at least one data byte on Serial
Data input (DQ0).
If the 8 least significant address bits (A7-A0) are not all zero, all transmitted data that goes
beyond the end of the current page are programmed from the start address of the same
page (from the address whose 8 least significant bits (A7-A0) are all zero). Chip Select (S)
must be driven Low for the entire duration of the sequence.
93/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
If more than 256 bytes are sent to the device, previously latched data are discarded and the
last 256 data bytes are guaranteed to be programmed correctly within the same page. If less
than 256 data bytes are sent to device, they are correctly programmed at the requested
addresses without having any effects on the other bytes in the same page.
For optimized timings, it is recommended to use the Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP)
instruction to program all consecutive targeted bytes in a single sequence rather to using
several Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) sequences each containing only a few bytes See
Table 32.: AC Characteristics.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last data byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction is not executed.
As soon as Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Page Program cycle (whose
duration is tPP) is initiated. While the Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) cycle is in progress,
the Status Register may be read to check the value of the Write In Progress (WIP) bit. The
Write In Progress (WIP) bit is 1 during the self-timed Page Program cycle, and 0 when it is
completed. At some unspecified time before the cycle is completed, the Write Enable Latch
(WEL) bit is reset.
A Quad Input Fast Program (QIFP) instruction applied to a page that is protected by the
Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0 and TB) bits is not executed.
A Quad Input Fast Program cycle can be paused by mean of Program/Erase Suspend
(PES) instruction and resumed by mean of Program/Erase Resume (PER) instruction.
Figure 23. Quad Input Fast Program instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
C
Instruction
1
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
4
Data In
Data In
Data In
24-bit address
2
3
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
5
1
5
1
5
1
6
2
6
2
6
7
3
7
3
7
5
6
0
4
0
4
0
5
1
5
1
5
1
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Don’t Care
DQ1
Don’t Care
DQ2
Don’t Care
DQ3
‘1’
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
Quad_Input_Fast_Program
9.1.15
Quad Input Extended Fast Program
The Quad Input Extended Fast Program (QIEFP) instruction is very similar to the Quad
Input Extended Fast Program (QIFP), except that the address bits are shifted in on four pins
(pin DQ0, pin DQ1, pin W/VPP/DQ2 and pin HOLD/DQ3) instead of only one.
94/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 24. Quad Input Extended Fast Program instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
C
Instruction
Data In
24-bit address
2
1
DQ0
Data In
Data In
3
5
4
7
6
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
23 19 15 11 7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Don’t Care
DQ1
Don’t Care
DQ2
DQ3
‘1’
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
Quad_Input_Extended_Fast_Program
9.1.16
Program OTP instruction (POTP)
The Program OTP instruction (POTP) is used to program at most 64 bytes to the OTP
memory area (by changing bits from 1 to 0, only). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable
(WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. After the Write Enable (WREN)
instruction has been decoded, the device sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
The Program OTP instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed by the
instruction opcode, three address bytes and at least one data byte on Serial Data input
(DQ0). Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last data byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Program OTP instruction is not executed.
There is no rollover mechanism with the Program OTP (POTP) instruction. This means that
the Program OTP (POTP) instruction must be sent with a maximum of 65 bytes to program,
once all 65 bytes have been latched in, any following byte will be discarded.
As soon as Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Page Program cycle (whose
duration is tPP) is initiated. While the Program OTP cycle is in progress, the Status Register
may be read to check the value of the Write In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write In Progress
(WIP) bit is 1 during the self-timed Program OTP cycle, and it is 0 when it is completed. At
some unspecified time before the cycle is complete, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is
reset.
To lock the OTP memory:
Bit 0 of the OTP control byte, that is byte 64, is used to permanently lock the OTP memory
array.
„
When bit 0 of byte 64 = '1', the 64 bytes of the OTP memory array can be programmed.
„
When bit 0 of byte 64 = '0', the 64 bytes of the OTP memory array are read-only and
cannot be programmed anymore.
95/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Once a bit of the OTP memory has been programmed to '0', it can no longer be set to '1'.
Therefore, as soon as bit 0 of byte 64 (control byte) is set to '0', the 64 bytes of the OTP
memory array become read-only in a permanent way.
Any Program OTP (POTP) instruction issued while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in
progress is rejected without having any effect on the cycle that is in progress.
Figure 25. Program OTP instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
9 10
C
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
Data byte 1
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
0
1
MSB
MSB
S
40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55
C
Data byte 2
DQ0
7
6
MSB
5
4
3
2
Data byte 3
1
0
7
MSB
6
5
4
3
2
Data byte n
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
AI13575
96/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 26. How to permanently lock the OTP bytes
64 data bytes
OTP control byte
Byte Byte Byte
0
1
2
Byte Byte
63 64
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
bit 0 When bit 0 = 0
the 64 OTP bytes
become read only
Bit 1 to bit 7 are not programmable
ai13587
9.1.17
Subsector Erase (SSE)
For devices with bottom or top architecture, at the bottom (or top) of the addressable area
there are 8 boot sectors, each one having 16 4Kbytes subsectors. The Subsector Erase
(SSE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside the chosen subsector. Before it can be
accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. After
the Write Enable (WREN) instruction has been decoded, the device sets the Write Enable
Latch (WEL).
The Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed
by the instruction code, and three address bytes on Serial Data input (DQ0). Any address
inside the subsector is a valid address for the Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction. Chip
Select (S) must be driven Low for the entire duration of the sequence.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last address byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction is not executed. As soon as
Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Subsector Erase cycle (whose duration is
tSSE) is initiated. While the Subsector Erase cycle is in progress, the Status Register may
be read to check the value of the Write In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write In Progress (WIP)
bit is 1 during the self-timed Subsector Erase cycle, and is 0 when it is completed. At some
unspecified time before the cycle is complete, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset.
A Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction issued to a sector that is hardware or software
protected, is not executed.
Any Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction, while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in
progress, is rejected without having any effects on the cycle that is in progress.
Any Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction in devices with uniform architecture (meaning no
boot sectors with subsectors) is rejected without having any effects on the device.
97/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 27. Subsector Erase instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
29 30 31
C
Instruction
DQ0
24 Bit Address
23 22
2
1
0
MSB
Subsector_Erase
9.1.18
Sector Erase (SE)
The Sector Erase (SE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside the chosen sector. Before it
can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
After the Write Enable (WREN) instruction has been decoded, the device sets the Write
Enable Latch (WEL).
The Sector Erase (SE) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed by the
instruction code, and three address bytes on Serial Data input (DQ0). Any address inside
the sector is a valid address for the Sector Erase (SE) instruction. Chip Select (S) must be
driven Low for the entire duration of the sequence.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the last address byte has been
latched in, otherwise the Sector Erase (SE) instruction is not executed. As soon as Chip
Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed Sector Erase cycle (whose duration is tSE) is
initiated. While the Sector Erase cycle is in progress, the Status Register may be read to
check the value of the Write In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write In Progress (WIP) bit is 1
during the self-timed Sector Erase cycle, and is 0 when it is completed. At some unspecified
time before the cycle is completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset.
A Sector Erase (SE) instruction applied to a page which is protected by the Block Protect
(BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0 and TB) bits is not executed.
A Sector Erase cycle can be paused by mean of Program/Erase Suspend (PES) instruction
and resumed by mean of Program/Erase Resume (PER) instruction.
98/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 28. Sector Erase instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
29 30 31
C
Instruction
24 Bit Address
23 22
DQ0
2
1
0
MSB
Sector_Erase
9.1.19
Bulk Erase (BE)
The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction sets all bits to '1' (FFh). Before it can be accepted, a Write
Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. After the Write Enable
(WREN) instruction has been decoded, the device sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL).
The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed by the
instruction code on Serial Data input (DQ0). Chip Select (S) must be driven Low for the
entire duration of the sequence.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the instruction code has been
latched in, otherwise the Bulk Erase instruction is not executed. As soon as Chip Select (S)
is driven High, the self-timed Bulk Erase cycle (whose duration is tBE) is initiated. While the
Bulk Erase cycle is in progress, the Status Register may be read to check the value of the
Write In Progress (WIP) bit. The Write In Progress (WIP) bit is 1 during the self-timed Bulk
Erase cycle, and is 0 when it is completed. At some unspecified time before the cycle is
completed, the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset.
The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction is executed only if all Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0)
bits are 0. The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction is ignored if one, or more, sectors are protected.
Figure 29. Bulk Erase instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
C
Instruction
DQ0
AI13743
99/180
Instructions
9.1.20
N25Q128 - 3 V
Program/Erase Suspend
The Program/Erase Suspend instruction allows the controller to interrupt a Program or an
Erase instruction, in particular: Sector Erase, Subsector Erase, Page Program, Dual Input
Page Program, Dual Input Extended Page program, Quad Input Page Program and Quad
Input Extended Page program can be suspended and erased.
Note:
Bulk Erase, Write Non Volatile Configuration register and Program OTP cannot be
suspended.
After a Program/Erase Suspend instruction the bit 2 of the Flag Status register is
immediately set to 1 and, after a latency time, both the WIP bit of the Status Register and
the Program/Erase controller bit (Not WIP) of the Flag Status Register are cleared (to 0 and
to 1 respectively).
The Suspended state is reset if a power-off is performed or after resume.
After a sector erase instruction has been suspended, another erase instruction is not
allowed; however, it is possible to perform program and reading instructions on all the
sectors except the one whose erase cycle is suspended. Any read instruction issued on this
sector outputs Don't Care data.
After a subsector erase instruction has been suspended, neither an erase instruction or a
program instruction is allowed; only a read instruction is allowed on all sectors except the
one containing the subsector whose erase cycle is suspended. Any read instruction issued
on this sector outputs Don't Care data.
After a program instruction has been suspended, neither a program instruction or an erase
instructions is allowed; however, it is possible to perform a read instruction on all pages
except the one whose program cycle is suspended. Any read instruction issued on this page
outputs Don't Care data.
It's possible to nest a suspend instruction inside another suspended one just once, meaning
that it's possible for example to send to the device an erase instruction, then suspend it,
then send a program instruction and in the end suspend it as well. In this case the next
Program/Erase Resume Instruction resumes the more recent suspended modify cycles,
another Program/Erase Resume Instruction is need to resume also the former one.
Table 17.
Suspend Parameters
Parameter
Condition
Typ
Max
Unit
Note
Erase to
Suspend
Sector Erase or Erase Resume to
Erase Suspend
40
µs
Timing not internally controlled
Program to
Suspend
Program Resume to Program
Suspend
5
µs
Timing not internally controlled
SSErase to
Suspend
Sub Sector Erase or Sub Sector
Erase Resume to Erase Suspend
40
µs
Timing not internally controlled
Suspend
Latency
Program
7
µs
Any Read instruction accepted
Sub Sector Erase
15
µs
Any Read instruction accepted
Erase
15
µs
Any instruction accepted but DP, SE,
SSE, BE, WRSR, WRNVCR, POTP
100/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 18.
Instructions
Operations Allowed / Disallowed During Device States
Device States and Sector (Same/Other) in Which Operation is Allowed/Disallowed (Yes/No)
Standby State Program State
Operation
Sector
Erase State
(SE/SSE)
Subsector
Erase
Suspended
State
Program
Suspended
State
Erase
Suspended
State
Sector
Sector
Sector
Sector
Sector
Same Other
Same
Other
Same Other Same Other Same Other Same Other
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
Yes(1) Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes(1) Yes
Array Program:
PP / DIFP /
Yes
QWIFP / DIEFP
/ QIEFP
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Yes
Sector Erase
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Sub-Sector
Erase
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
All Reads
except RDSR /
RDFSR
WRLR / POTP /
BE / WRSR /
Yes
WRNVCR
No
No
No
No
No
WVCR /
WVECR
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
RDSR / RDFSR Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Program /
No
Erase Suspend
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
1. The Read operation is accepted but the data output is not guaranetted until the program or erase has completed.
Note:
The device can be in only one state at a time, such as Standby, Program, Erase, and so on.
Device states are shown in Table 18.: Operations Allowed / Disallowed During Device
States.
9.1.21
Program/Erase Resume
After a Program/Erase suspend instruction, a Program/Erase Resume instruction is
required to continue performing the suspended Program or Erase sequence.
Program/Erase Resume instruction is ignored if the device is not in a Program/Erase
Suspended status. The WIP bit of the Status Register and Program/Erase controller bit (Not
WIP) of the Flag Status Register both switch to the busy state (1 and 0 respectively) after
Program/Erase Resume instruction until the Program or Erase sequence is completed.
In this case the next Program/Erase Resume Instruction resumes the more recent
suspended modify cycles, another Program/Erase Resume Instruction is need to resume
also the former one.
101/180
Instructions
9.1.22
N25Q128 - 3 V
Read Status Register (RDSR)
The Read Status Register (RDSR) instruction allows the Status Register to be read. The
Status Register may be read at any time, even while a Program, Erase or Write Status
Register cycle is in progress. When one of these cycles is in progress, it is recommended to
check the Write In Progress (WIP) bit (or the Program/Erase controller bit of the Flag Status
Register) before sending a new instruction to the device. It is also possible to read the
Status Register continuously, as shown here.
Figure 30. Read Status Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
DQ0
Status register out
Status register out
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
MSB
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
AI13734
9.1.23
Write status register (WRSR)
The write status register (WRSR) instruction allows new values to be written to the status
register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have
been executed. After the write enable (WREN) instruction has been decoded and executed,
the device sets the write enable latch (WEL).
The write status register (WRSR) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low,
followed by the instruction code and the data byte on serial data input (DQ0).
The write status register (WRSR) instruction has no effect on b1 and b0 of the status
register.
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the data byte has been latched in.
If not, the write status register (WRSR) instruction is not executed. As soon as Chip Select
(S) is driven High, the self-timed write status register cycle (whose duration is tow) is
initiated. While the write status register cycle is in progress, the status register may still be
read to check the value of the write in progress (WIP) bit. The write in progress (WIP) bit is 1
during the self-timed write status register cycle, and is 0 when it is completed. When the
cycle is completed, the write enable latch (WEL) is reset.
The write status register (WRSR) instruction allows the user to change the values of the
block protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits, to define the size of the area that is to be treated
as read-only, as defined in Table 3. The write status register (WRSR) instruction also allows
the user to set and reset the status register write disable (SRWD) bit in accordance with the
Write Protect (W/VPP) signal. The status register write disable (SRWD) bit and Write Protect
(W/VPP) signal allow the device to be put in the hardware protected mode (HPM). The write
102/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
status register (WRSR) instruction is not executed once the hardware protected mode
(HPM) is entered.
Figure 31. Write Status Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
Status
register in
7
DQ0
High Impedance
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
DQ1
AI13735
The protection features of the device are summarized in Table 8.
When the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit of the Status Register is 0 (its initial
delivery state), it is possible to write to the Status Register provided that the Write Enable
Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set by a Write Enable (WREN) instruction, regardless
of the whether Write Protect (W/VPP) is driven High or Low.
When the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit of the Status Register is set to '1', two
cases need to be considered, depending on the state of Write Protect (W/VPP):
„
If Write Protect (W/VPP) is driven High, it is possible to write to the Status Register
provided that the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set by a Write
Enable (WREN) instruction.
„
If Write Protect (W/VPP) is driven Low, it is not possible to write to the Status Register
even if the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit has previously been set by a Write Enable
(WREN) instruction (attempts to write to the Status Register are rejected, and are not
accepted for execution). As a consequence, all the data bytes in the memory area that
are software protected (SPM) by the Block Protect (BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits of the
Status Register, are also hardware protected against data modification.
Regardless of the order of the two events, the Hardware Protected mode (HPM) can be
entered in either of the following ways:
„
setting the Status Register Write Disable (SRWD) bit after driving Write Protect
(W/VPP) Low
„
driving Write Protect (W/VPP) Low after setting the Status Register Write Disable
(SRWD) bit.
The only way to exit the Hardware Protected mode (HPM) once entered is to pull Write
Protect (W/VPP) High.
If Write Protect (W/VPP) is permanently tied High, the Hardware Protected mode (HPM) can
never be activated, and only the Software Protected mode (SPM), using the Block Protect
(BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits of the Status Register, can be used.
103/180
Instructions
Table 19.
W / VPP
Signal
Protection modes
SRWD
bit
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
N25Q128 - 3 V
1
Mode
Write protection of the status
register
Memory content
Protected area (1)
Unprotected area (1)
Software
protected
(SPM)
Status register is writeable, if the
WREN instruction has set the WEL
bit.
The values in the SRWD, TB, BP3,
BP2, BP1, and BP0 bits can be
changed.
Protected against PP,
DIFP, DIEFP, QIFP,
QIEFP, SSE, SE and
BE instructions.
Ready to accept PP,
DIFP, DIEFP, QIFP,
QIEFP, SSE, and SE
instructions.
Hardware
protected
(HPM)
Status Register is hardware write
protected. The values in the
SRWD, TB, BP3, BP2, BP1 and
BP0 bits cannot be changed
PP, DIFP, DIEFP,
QIFP, QIEFP, SSE,
SE and BE
instructions.
PP, DIFP, DIEFP,
QIFP, QIEFP, SSE,
and SE instructions.
1. As defined by the values in the Block Protect (TB, BP3, BP2, BP1, BP0) bits of the Status Register, as shown in Table 2:
Status register format.
9.1.24
Read Lock Register (RDLR)
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. The instruction code for the Read
Lock Register (RDLR) instruction is followed by a 3-byte address (A23-A0) pointing to any
location inside the concerned sector. Each address bit is latched-in during the rising edge of
Serial Clock (C). Then the value of the Lock Register is shifted out on Serial Data output
(DQ1), each bit being shifted out, at a maximum frequency fC, during the falling edge of
Serial Clock (C).
The Read Lock Register (RDLR) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High at
any time during data output.
Any Read Lock Register (RDLR) instruction, while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in
progress, is rejected without having any effects on the cycle that is in progress.
Figure 32. Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
C
Instruction
24-bit address
23 22 21
DQ0
3
2
1
0
MSB
Lock register out
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
AI13738
104/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 20.
Bit
Instructions
Lock Register out(1)
Bit name
Value
Function
b7-b2
b1
b0
Reserved
Sector Lock
Down
‘1’
The Write Lock and Lock Down bits cannot be changed. Once a ‘1’ is written to the
Lock Down bit it cannot be cleared to ‘0’, except by a power-up.
‘0’
The Write Lock and Lock Down bits can be changed by writing new values to them.
‘1’
Write, Program and Erase operations in this sector will not be executed. The
memory contents will not be changed.
‘0’
Write, Program and Erase operations in this sector are executed and will modify the
sector contents.
Sector
Write Lock
1. Values of (b1, b0) after power-up are defined in Section 7: Protection modes.
9.1.25
Write to Lock Register (WRLR)
The Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction allows bits to be changed in the Lock
Registers. Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously
have been executed. After the Write Enable (WREN) instruction has been decoded, the
device sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL).
The Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction is entered by driving Chip Select (S) Low,
followed by the instruction code, three address bytes (pointing to any address in the
targeted sector and one data byte on Serial Data input (DQ0). The instruction sequence is
shown in Figure 22. Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the data byte
has been latched in, otherwise the Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction is not
executed.
Lock Register bits are volatile, and therefore do not require time to be written. When the
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction has been successfully executed, the Write
Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset after a delay time less than tSHSL minimum value.
Any Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction, while an Erase, Program or Write cycle is in
progress, is rejected without having any effects on the cycle that is in progress.
Figure 33. Write to Lock Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
C
Instruction
DQ0
Lock register
in
24-bit address
23 22 21
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
AI13740
105/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 21.
Lock Register in(1)
Sector
Bit
Value
b7-b2
‘0’
All sectors
b1
Sector Lock Down bit value (refer to Table 20)
b0
Sector Write Lock bit value (refer to Table 20)
1. Values of (b1, b0) after power-up are defined in Section 7: Protection modes.
9.1.26
Read Flag Status Register
The Read Flag Status Register (RFSR) instruction allows the Flag Status Register to be
read. The Status Register may be read at any time, even while a Program, Erase. When one
of these cycles is in progress, it is recommended to check the P/E Controller bit (Not WIP)
bit before sending a new instruction to the device. It is also possible to read the Flag
Register continuously, as shown here.
Figure 34. Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
DQ0
Flag Status Register Out
Flag Status Register Out
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
4
MSB
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
Read_Flag_SR
9.1.27
Clear Flag Status Register
The Clear Flag Status Register (CLFSR) instruction reset the error Flag Status Register bits
(Erase Error bit, Program Error bit, VPP Error bit, Protection Error bit). It is not necessary to
set the WEL bit before the Clear Flag Status Register instruction is executed. The WEL bit
will be unchanged after this command is executed.
106/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 35. Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
C
Instruction
DQ0
High Impedance
MSB
DQ1
Clear_Flag_SR
9.1.28
Read NV Configuration Register
The Read Non Volatile Configuration Register (RDNVCR) instruction allows the Non Volatile
Configuration Register to be read.
Figure 36. Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
C
Instruction
DQ0
NVCR Out
NVCR Out
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
4
3
LS Byte
2
1
0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
MS Byte
Read_NVCR
9.1.29
Write NV Configuration Register
The Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction allows new values to
be written to the Non Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write
enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. After the write enable
(WREN) instruction has been decoded and executed, the device sets the write enable latch
(WEL).
The Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction is entered by driving
Chip Select (S) Low, followed by the instruction code and the data bytes on serial data input
(DQ0).
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the 16th bit of the data bytes has been latched in.
If not, the Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction is not executed.
107/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
As soon as Chip Select (S) is driven High, the self-timed write NV configuration register
cycle (whose duration is tnvcr) is initiated.
While the Write Non Volatile Configuration register cycle is in progress, it is possible to
monitor the end of the process by polling status Register write in progress (WIP) bit or the
Flag Status Register Program/Erase Controller bit. The write in progress (WIP) bit is 1
during the self-timed Write Non Volatile Configuration register cycle, and is 0 when it is
completed. When the cycle is completed, the write enable latch (WEL) is reset.
The Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction allows the user to
change the values of all the Non Volatile Configuration Register bits, described in Table 3.:
Non-Volatile Configuration Register.
The Write Non Volatile Configuration Register impacts the memory behavior only after the
next power on sequence.
Figure 37. Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
C
NVCR In
Instruction
Byte
7
DQ0
6
5
4
Byte
3
LS Byte
2
1
0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
8
MS Byte
High Impedance
DQ1
Write_NVCR
9.1.30
Read Volatile Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Configuration Register (RDVCR) instruction allows the Volatile
Configuration Register to be read. See Table 5.: Volatile Configuration Register.
108/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 38. Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
DQ0
Volatile Configuration
Register Out
High Impedance
DQ1
7
6
5
4
3
2
MSB
1
Volatile Configuration
Register Out
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
Read_VCR
9.1.31
Write Volatile Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction allows new values to be
written to the Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable
(WREN) instruction must have been executed. After the write enable (WREN) instruction
has been decoded and executed, the device sets the write enable latch (WEL).
In case of Fast POR (see section 11.1 for further details) the WREN instruction is not
required because a WREN instruction gets the device out from the Fast POR state.
The Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction is entered by driving Chip
Select (S) Low, followed by the instruction code and the data byte on serial data input
(DQ0).
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the data byte has been latched in.
If not, the Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction is not executed.
When the new data are latched, the write enable latch (WEL) is reset.
The Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction allows the user to change the
values of all the Volatile Configuration Register bits, described in Table 5.: Volatile
Configuration Register.
The Write Volatile Configuration Register impacts the memory behavior right after the
instruction is received by the device.
109/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 39. Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
Volatile Configuration
Register In
7
DQ0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
High Impedance
DQ1
Write_VCR
9.1.32
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) instruction allows the
Volatile Configuration Register to be read.
Figure 40. Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
DQ0
High Impedance
DQ1
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register Out
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register Out
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
MSB
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
MSB
Read_VECR
9.1.33
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction allows new
values to be written to the Volatile Enhanced Configuration register. Before it can be
accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. After the
write enable (WREN) instruction has been decoded and executed, the device sets the write
enable latch (WEL). In case of Fast POR, the WREN instruction is not required because a
WREN instruction gets the device out from the Fast POR state (see Section 11.1: Fast
POR).
110/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction is entered by
driving Chip Select (S) Low, followed by the instruction code and the data byte on serial data
input (DQ0).
Chip Select (S) must be driven High after the eighth bit of the data byte has been latched in.
If not, the Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction is not
executed.
When the new data are latched, the write enable latch (WEL) is reset.
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction allows the user to
change the values of all the Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register bits, described in
Table 6.: Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register.
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register impacts the memory behavior right after
the instruction is received by the device.
Figure 41. Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
VECR In
7
DQ0
High Impedance
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
DQ1
Write_VECR
9.2
DIO-SPI Instructions
In DIO-SPI protocol, instructions, addresses and input/Output data always run in parallel on
two wires: DQ0 and DQ1.
In the case of a Dual Command Fast Read (DCFR), Read OTP (ROTP), Read Lock
Registers (RDLR), Read Status Register (RDSR), Read Flag Status Register (RFSR), Read
NV Configuration Register (RDNVCR), Read Volatile Configuration Register (RDVCR),
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) and Read Identification (RDID)
instruction, the shifted-in instruction sequence is followed by a data-out sequence. Chip
Select (S) can be driven High after any bit of the data-out sequence is being shifted out.
In the case of a Dual Command Page Program (DCPP), Program OTP (POTP), Subsector
Erase (SSE), Sector Erase (SE), Bulk Erase (BE), Program/Erase Suspend (PES),
Program/Erase Resume (PER), Write Status Register (WRSR), Clear Flag Status Register
(CLFSR), Write to Lock Register (WRLR), Write Configuration Register (WRVCR), Write
111/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Enhanced Configuration Register (WRVECR), Write NV Configuration Register
(WRNVCR), Write Enable (WREN) or Write Disable (WRDI) instruction, Chip Select (S)
must be driven High exactly at a byte boundary, otherwise the instruction is rejected, and is
not executed.
All attempts to access the memory array during a Write Status Register cycle, a Write Non
Volatile Configuration Register, a Program cycle or an Erase cycle are ignored, and the
internal Write Status Register cycle, Write Non Volatile Configuration Register, Program
cycle or Erase cycle continues unaffected, the only exception is the Program/Erase
Suspend instruction (PES), that can be used to pause all the program and the erase cycles
but the Program OTP (POT),, Bulk Erase (BE) and Write Non Volatile Configuration
Register. The suspended program or erase cycle can be resumed by mean of the
Program/Erase Resume instruction (PER). During the program/erase cycles also the polling
instructions (to check if the internal modify cycle is finished by mean of the WIP bit of the
Status Register or of the Program/Erase controller bit of the Flag Status register) are also
accepted to allow the application checking the end of the internal modify cycles, of course
these polling instructions don't affect the internal cycles performing.
Table 22.
Instruction set: DIO-SPI protocol (page 1 of 2)
Instruction
MIORDID
DCFR
Description
Multiple I/O read identification
Dual Command Fast Read
One-byte
Instruction
Code (BIN)
One-byte
Dummy
Instruction Address
clock
Code
bytes
cycle
(HEX)
Data
bytes
1010 1111
AFh
0
0
1 to 3
0000 1011
0Bh
3
8 (1)
1 to ∞
0011 1011
3Bh
3
8(1)
1 to ∞
1011 1011
BBh
3
8
(1)
1 to ∞
(1)
1 to 65
ROTP
Read OTP
0100 1011
4Bh
3
8
WREN
Write Enable
0000 0110
06h
0
0
0
WRDI
Write Disable
0000 0100
04h
0
0
0
0000 0010
02h
3
0
1 to 256
1010 0010
A2h
3
0
1 to 256
1101 0010
D2h
3
0
1 to 256
Program OTP
0100 0010
42h
3
0
1 to 65
SubSector Erase
0010 0000
20h
3
0
0
SE
Sector Erase
1101 1000
D8h
3
0
0
BE
Bulk Erase
1100 0111
C7h
0
0
0
PER
Program/Erase Resume
0111 1010
7Ah
0
0
0
PES
Program/Erase Suspend
0111 0101
75h
0
0
0
RDSR
Read Status Register
0000 0101
05h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRSR
Write Status Register
0000 0001
01h
0
0
1
RDLR
Read Lock Register
1110 1000
E8h
3
0
1 to ∞
WRLR
Write to Lock Register
1110 0101
E5h
3
0
1
DCPP
POTP
SSE
(2)
112/180
Dual Command Page Program
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 22.
Instructions
Instruction set: DIO-SPI protocol (page 2 of 2)
Instruction
Description
One-byte
Instruction
Code (BIN)
One-byte
Dummy
Instruction Address
clock
Code
bytes
cycle
(HEX)
Data
bytes
RFSR
Read Flag Status Register
0111 0000
70h
0
0
1 to ∞
CLFSR
Clear Flag Status Register
0101 0000
50h
0
0
0
RDNVCR
Read NV Configuration Register
1011 0101
B5h
0
0
2
WRNVCR
Write NV Configuration Register
1011 0001
B1h
0
0
2
RDVCR
Read Volatile Configuration Register
1000 0101
85h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVCR
Write Volatile Configuration Register
1000 0001
81h
0
0
1
RDVECR
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration
Register
0110 0101
65h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVECR
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration
Register
0110 0001
61h
0
0
1
1) The
number of Dummy Clock cycles is configurable by the user
2) SSE is only available in devices with Bottom or Top architecture.
9.2.1
Multiple I/O Read Identification protocol
The Multiple Input/Output Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction allows to read the
device identification data in the DIO-SPI protocol:
–
Manufacturer identification (1 byte)
–
Device identification (2 bytes)
Unlike the RDID instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, the Multiple Input/Output
instruction can not read the Unique ID code (UID) (17 bytes).
For further details on the manufacturer and device identification codes please refer to
Section 9.1.1: Read Identification (RDID).
Any Multiple Input/Output Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction while an Erase or
Program cycle is in progress, is not decoded, and has no effect on the cycle that is in
progress.
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. Then, the 8-bit instruction code
for the instruction is shifted in parallel on the 2 pins DQ0 and DQ1. After this, the 24-bit
device identification, stored in the memory, will be shifted out on again in parallel on DQ1
and DQ0. Each two bits are shifted out during the falling edge of Serial Clock (C).
The Read Identification (RDID) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High at
any time during data output.
When Chip Select (S) is driven High, the device is put in the Standby Power mode. Once in
the Standby Power mode, the device waits to be selected, so that it can receive, decode and
execute instructions.
113/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 42. Multiple I/O Read Identification instruction and data-out sequence DIOSPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
DEV.
code
MAN.
code
AFh
SIZE
code
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Multi_Read_IO
9.2.2
Dual Command Fast Read (DCFR)
The Dual Command Fast Read (DCFR) instruction allows to read the memory in DIO-SPI
protocol, parallelizing the instruction code, the address and the output data on two pins
(DQ0 and DQ1). The Dual Command Fast Read (DCFR) instruction can be issued, when
the device is set in DIO-SPI mode, by sending to the memory indifferently one of the 3
instructions codes: 0Bh, 3Bh or BBh, the effect is exactly the same. The 3 instruction codes
are all accepted to help the application code porting from Extended SPI protocol to DIO-SPI
protocol.
Apart for the parallelizing on two pins of the instruction code, the Dual Command Fast Read
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Dual I/O Fast Read of the Extended SPI
protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.5: Dual I/O Fast Read for further details.
Figure 43. Dual Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data Out n
Data Out 1
Dummy cycles
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
MSB
MSB
Dual_Command_Fast_Read
114/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
9.2.3
Instructions
Read OTP (ROTP)
The Read OTP (ROTP) instruction is used to read the 64 bytes OTP area in the DIO-SPI
protocol. The instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read OTP instruction of the
Extended SPI protocol; the only difference is that in the DIO-SPI protocol instruction code,
address and output data are all parallelized on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1.
Note:
The dummy bits can not be parallelized since these clock cycles are requested to perform
the internal reading operation.
Figure 44. Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
Data Out n
Data Out 1
Dummy cycles
6
4
2
0
7
5
3
1
MSB
6
4
2
0
7
5
3
1
MSB
Dual_Read_OTP
9.2.4
Write Enable (WREN)
The Write Enable (WREN) instruction sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Enable (WREN) instruction of the
Extended SPI protocol.
Figure 45. Write Enable instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Write_Enable
115/180
Instructions
9.2.5
N25Q128 - 3 V
Write Disable (WRDI)
The Write Disable (WRDI) instruction resets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Disable (WRDI) instruction of the
Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.10: Write Disable (WRDI) for further
details.
Figure 46. Write Disable instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Write_Disable
9.2.6
Dual Command Page Program (DCPP)
The Dual Command Page Program (DCPP) instruction allows to program the memory
content in DIO-SPI protocol, parallelizing the instruction code, the address and the input
data on two pins (DQ0 and DQ1). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN)
instruction must previously have been executed. The Dual Command Page Program
(DCPP) instruction can be issued, when the device is set in DIO-SPI mode, by sending to
the memory indifferently one of the 3 instructions codes: 02h, A2h or D2h, the effect is
exactly the same. The 3 instruction codes are all accepted to help the application code
porting from Extended SPI protocol to DIO-SPI protocol.
Apart for the parallelizing on two pins of the instruction code, the Dual Command Page
Program instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Dual Input Extended Fast
Program of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.13: Dual Input Extended
Fast Program for further details.
116/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 47. Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, 02h
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
1037 1039
1036 1038
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 256
Data Byte 2
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Page_Program_02h
Figure 48. Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, A2h
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
1037 1039
1036 1038
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 256
Data Byte 2
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Page_Program_A2h
Figure 49. Dual Command Page Program instruction sequence DSP, D2h
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
1037 1039
1036 1038
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data Byte 1
Data Byte 256
Data Byte 2
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Page_Program_D2h
117/180
Instructions
9.2.7
N25Q128 - 3 V
Program OTP instruction (POTP)
The Program OTP instruction (POTP) is used to program at most 64 bytes to the OTP
memory area (by changing bits from 1 to 0, only). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable
(WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, address and input data on the two pins
DQ0 and DQ1, the instruction functionality (as well as the locking OTP method) is exactly
the same as the Program OTP (POTP) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please
refer to Section 9.1.16: Program OTP instruction (POTP) for further details.
Figure 50. Program OTP instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data Byte 1
Data Byte n
Data Byte 2
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Program_OTP
9.2.8
Subsector Erase (SSE)
For devices with bottom or top architecture, at the bottom (or top) of the addressable area
there are 8 boot sectors, each one having 16 4Kbytes subsectors. The Subsector Erase
(SSE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside the chosen subsector. Before it can be
accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the address on the two pins DQ0 and
DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Subsector Erase (SSE)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.17: Subsector Erase
(SSE) for further details.
118/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 51. Subsector Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
9
10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10
8
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11
9
7
5
3
1
Dual_Subsector_Erase
9.2.9
Sector Erase (SE)
The Sector Erase (SE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside the chosen sector. Before it
can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the address on the two pins DQ0 and
DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Sector Erase (SE) instruction of
the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.18: Sector Erase (SE) for further
details.
Figure 52. Sector Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
Dual_Sector_Erase
119/180
Instructions
9.2.10
N25Q128 - 3 V
Bulk Erase (BE)
The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction sets all bits to '1' (FFh). Before it can be accepted, a Write
Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Bulk Erase (BE) instruction of the
Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.19: Bulk Erase (BE) for further details.
Figure 53. Bulk Erase instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Bulk_Erase
9.2.11
Program/Erase Suspend
The Program/Erase Suspend instruction allows the controller to interrupt a Program or an
Erase instruction, in particular: Sector Erase and Dual Command Page Program can be
suspended and erased while Subsector Erase, Bulk Erase, Write Non Volatile Configuration
register, and Program OTP cannot be suspended.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Program/Erase Suspend (PES)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol.
120/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 54. Program/Erase Suspend instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Program_Erase_Suspend
9.2.12
Program/Erase Resume
After a Program/Erase suspend instruction, a Program/Erase Resume instruction is
required to continue performing the suspended Program or Erase sequence.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Program/Erase Resume (PER)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.21: Program/Erase
Resume for further details.
Figure 55. Program/Erase Resume instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Program_Erase_Resume
121/180
Instructions
9.2.13
N25Q128 - 3 V
Read Status Register (RDSR)
The Read Status Register (RDSR) instruction allows the Status Register to be read. Apart
form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the output data on the two pins DQ0 and
DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read Status Register (RDSR)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.22: Read Status
Register (RDSR) for further details.
Figure 56. Read Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
9 10 11
C
Status Register Out
Byte
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Read_SR
9.2.14
Write status register (WRSR)
The write status register (WRSR) instruction allows new values to be written to the status
register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have
been executed. Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the
two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the instruction functionality and the protection feature management
is exactly the same as the Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction of the Extended SPI
protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.23: Write status register (WRSR) for further details.
Figure 57. Write Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
C
Status Register In
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Write_SR
122/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
9.2.15
Instructions
Read Lock Register (RDLR)
The Read Lock Register instructions is used to read the lock register content.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, the address and the output data on the
two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read Lock
Register (RDLR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.24:
Read Lock Register (RDLR) for further details.
Figure 58. Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Lock Register Out
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Read_LR
9.2.16
Write to Lock Register (WRLR)
The Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction allows bits to be changed in the Lock
Registers. Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously
have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, the address and the input data on the
two pins DQ0 and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write to Lock
Register (WRLR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.25:
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) for further details.
123/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 59. Write to Lock Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 12 13 14 15
8
7
C
Instruction
Lock Register In
24-Bit Address
DQ0
22 20 18 16 14 12 10 8
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
23 21 19 17 15 13 11 9
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Write_LR
9.2.17
Read Flag Status Register
The Read Flag Status Register (RFSR) instruction allows the Flag Status Register to be
read.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the output data on the two pins DQ0
and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read Flag Status Register
(RFSR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.26: Read Flag
Status Register for further details.
Figure 60. Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
Instruction
Flag Status Register Out
Byte
Byte
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Read_Flag_SR
124/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
9.2.18
Instructions
Clear Flag Status Register
The Clear Flag Status Register (CLFSR) instruction reset the error Flag Status Register bits
(Erase Error bit, Program Error bit, VPP Error bit, Protection Error bit). It is not necessary to
set the WEL bit before the Clear Flag Status Register instruction is executed. The WEL bit
will be unchanged after this command is executed.
Figure 61. Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
Dual_Clear_Flag_SR
9.2.19
Read NV Configuration Register
The Read Non Volatile Configuration Register (RDNVCR) instruction allows the Non Volatile
Configuration Register to be read.
Figure 62. Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
NVCR Out
Byte
Instruction
Byte
DQ0
6
4
2
0
14 12 10 8
DQ1
7
5
3
1
15 13 11 9
LS Byte
MS Byte
Dual_Read_NVCR
125/180
Instructions
9.2.20
N25Q128 - 3 V
Write NV Configuration Register
The Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction allows new values to
be written to the Non Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write
enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the two pins DQ0
and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Non Volatile
Configuration Register (WNVCR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.29: Write NV Configuration Register for further details.
Figure 63. Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
NVCR In
Byte
Instruction
Byte
DQ0
6
4
2
0
14 12 10 8
DQ1
7
5
3
1
15 13 11 9
LS Byte
MS Byte
Dual_Write_NVCR
9.2.21
Read Volatile Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Configuration Register (RDVCR) instruction allows the Volatile
Configuration Register to be read. See Table 5.: Volatile Configuration Register.
126/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 64. Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
Volatile Configuration
Register Out
Byte
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Read_VCR
9.2.22
Write Volatile Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction allows new values to be
written to the Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable
(WREN) instruction must have been executed previously. In case of Fast POR, the WREN
instruction is not required because a WREN instruction gets the device out from the Fast
POR state (See Section 11.1: Fast POR).
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the two pins DQ0
and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Volatile Configuration
Register (WVCR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.31:
Write Volatile Configuration Register for further details.
Figure 65. Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
Volatile Configuration
Register In
Byte
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Write_VCR
127/180
Instructions
9.2.23
N25Q128 - 3 V
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) instruction allows the
Volatile Configuration Register to be read.
Figure 66. Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register Out
Byte
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Read_VECR
9.2.24
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction allows new
values to be written to the Volatile Enhanced Configuration register. Before it can be
accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. In case
of Fast POR, the WREN instruction is not required because a WREN instruction gets the
device out from the Fast POR state (See Section 11.1: Fast POR).
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the two pins DQ0
and DQ1, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register (WRVECR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.33: Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register for further details.
128/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 67. Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
DIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11
C
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register In
Byte
Byte
Instruction
DQ0
6
4
2
0
6
4
2
0
DQ1
7
5
3
1
7
5
3
1
Dual_Write_VECR
9.3
QIO-SPI Instructions
In QIO-SPI protocol, instructions, addresses and Input/Output data always run in parallel on
four wires: DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3 with the already mentioned exception of the modify
instruction (erase and program) performed with the VPP=VPPh.
In the case of a Quad Command Fast Read (QCFR), Read OTP (ROTP), Read Lock
Registers (RDLR), Read Status Register (RDSR), Read Flag Status Register (RFSR), Read
NV Configuration Register (RDNVCR), Read Volatile Configuration Register (RDVCR),
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) and Read Identification (RDID)
instruction, the shifted-in instruction sequence is followed by a data-out sequence. Chip
Select (S) can be driven High after any bit of the data-out sequence is being shifted out.
In the case of a Quad Command Page Program (QCPP), Program OTP (POTP), Subsector
Erase (SSE), Sector Erase (SE), Bulk Erase (BE), Program/Erase Suspend (PES),
Program/Erase Resume (PER), Write Status Register (WRSR), Clear Flag Status Register
(CLFSR), Write to Lock Register (WRLR), Write Configuration Register (WRVCR), Write
Enhanced Configuration Register (WRVECR), Write NV Configuration Register (WRNVCR),
Write Enable (WREN) or Write Disable (WRDI) instruction, Chip Select (S) must be driven
High exactly at a byte boundary, otherwise the instruction is rejected, and is not executed.
All attempts to access the memory array during a Write Status Register cycle, a Write Non
Volatile Configuration Register, a Program cycle or an Erase cycle are ignored, and the
internal Write Status Register cycle, Write Non Volatile Configuration Register, Program
cycle or Erase cycle continues unaffected, the only exception is the Program/Erase
Suspend instruction (PES), that can be used to pause all the program and the erase cycles
but the Program OTP (POT),, Bulk Erase (BE) and Write Non Volatile Configuration
Register. The suspended program or erase cycle can be resumed by mean of the
Program/Erase Resume instruction (PER). During the program/erase cycles also the polling
instructions (to check if the internal modify cycle is finished by mean of the WIP bit of the
129/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Status Register or of the Program/Erase controller bit of the Flag Status register) are also
accepted to allow the application checking the end of the internal modify cycles, of course
these polling instructions don't affect the internal cycles performing.
Table 23.
Instruction set: QIO-SPI protocol
Instruction
MIORDID
Description
Multiple I/O read identification
One-byte
Instruction
Code (BIN)
1010 1111
0000 1011
QCFR
Quad Command Fast Read
One-byte
Dummy
Instruction Address
clock
Code
bytes
cycle
(HEX)
AFh
0Bh
0
3
0
Data
bytes
1 to 3
10
(1)
1 to ∞
(1)
1 to ∞
0110 1011
6Bh
3
10
1110 1011
EBh
3
10 (1)
1 to ∞
ROTP
Read OTP (Read of OTP area)
0100 1011
4Bh
3
10 (1)
1 to 65
WREN
Write Enable
0000 0110
06h
0
0
0
WRDI
Write Disable
0000 0100
04h
0
0
0
0000 0010
02h
3
0
1 to 256
0011 0010
32h
3
0
1 to 256
0001 0010
12h
3
0
1 to 256
QCPP
Quad Command Page Program
POTP
Program OTP (Program of OTP
area)
0100 0010
42h
3
0
1 to 65
SSE(2)
SubSector Erase
0010 0000
20h
3
0
0
SE
Sector Erase
1101 1000
D8h
3
0
0
BE
Bulk Erase
1100 0111
C7h
0
0
0
PER
Program/Erase Resume
0111 1010
7Ah
0
0
0
PES
Program/Erase Suspend
0111 0101
75h
0
0
0
RDSR
Read Status Register
0000 0101
05h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRSR
Write Status Register
0000 0001
01h
0
0
1
RDLR
Read Lock Register
1110 1000
E8h
3
0
1 to ∞
WRLR
Write to Lock Register
1110 0101
E5h
3
0
1
RFSR
Read Flag Status Register
0111 0000
70h
0
0
1 to ∞
CLFSR
Clear Flag Status Register
0101 0000
50h
0
0
0
RDNVCR
Read NV Configuration Register
1011 0101
B5h
0
0
2
WRNVCR
Write NV Configuration Register
1011 0001
B1h
0
0
2
RDVCR
Read Volatile Configuration Register 1000 0101
85h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVCR
Write Volatile Configuration Register 1000 0001
81h
0
0
1
RDVECR
Read Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register
0110 0101
65h
0
0
1 to ∞
WRVECR
Write Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register
0110 0001
61h
0
0
1
130/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
1) The
number of Dummy Clock cycles is configurable by the user.
2) SSE is only available in devices with Bottom or Top architecture
9.3.1
Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID)
The Multiple Input/Output Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction allows to read the
device identification data in the QIO-SPI protocol:
„
Manufacturer identification (1 byte)
„
Device identification (2 bytes)
Unlike the RDID instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, the Multiple Input/Output
instruction can not read the Unique ID code (UID) (17 bytes).
For further details on the manufacturer and device identification codes, see 9.1.1: Read
Identification (RDID).
Any Multiple Input/Output Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction while an Erase or
Program cycle is in progress, is not decoded, and has no effect on the cycle that is in
progress.
The device is first selected by driving Chip Select (S) Low. Then, the 8-bit instruction code
for the instruction is shifted in parallel on the 4 pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3. After this, the
24-bit device identification, stored in the memory, will be shifted out on again in parallel on
DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3. The identification bits are shifted out 4 at a time during the falling
edge of Serial Clock (C).
The Read Identification (RDID) instruction is terminated by driving Chip Select (S) High at
any time during data output.
When Chip Select (S) is driven High, the device is put in the Standby Power mode. Once in
the Standby Power mode, the device waits to be selected, so that it can receive, decode and
execute instructions.
Multiple I/O Read Identification (MIORDID) instruction sequence and data-out sequence
QIO-SPI.
131/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 68. Multiple I/O Read Identification instruction and data-out sequence QIOSPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
MAN.
code
DEV.
code
SIZE
code
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
AFh
Quad_Multi_Read_IO
9.3.2
Quad Command Fast Read (QCFR)
The Quad Command Fast Read (QCFR) instruction allows to read the memory in QIO-SPI
protocol, parallelizing the instruction code, the address and the output data on four pins
(DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3). The Quad Command Fast Read (QCFR) instruction can be
issued, after the device is set in QIO-SPI mode, by sending to the memory indifferently one
of the 3 instructions codes: 0Bh, 6Bh or EBh, the effect is exactly the same. The 3
instruction codes are all accepted to help the application code porting from Extended SPI
protocol to QIO-SPI protocol.
Apart for the parallelizing on four pins of the instruction code, the Quad Command Fast
Read instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Quad I/O Fast Read of the
Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.7: Quad I/O Fast Read for further details.
132/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 69. Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, 0Bh
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
4
0
4
0
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
4
0
4
0
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
4
0
4
0
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 Byte 5 Byte 6
Quad_Command_Fast_Read_0Bh
Figure 70. Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, 6Bh
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
4
0
4
0
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
4
0
4
0
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
4
0
4
0
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 Byte 5 Byte 6
Quad_Command_Fast_Read_EBh
133/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 71. Quad Command Fast Read instruction and data-out sequence QSP, EBh
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
4
0
4
0
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
4
0
4
0
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
4
0
4
0
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Byte 1 Byte 2 Byte 3 Byte 4 Byte 5 Byte 6
Quad_Command_Fast_Read_EBh
9.3.3
Read OTP (ROTP)
The Read OTP (ROTP) instruction is used to read the 64 bytes OTP area in the QIO-SPI
protocol. The instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read OTP instruction of the
Extended SPI protocol. The only difference is that in the QIO-SPI protocol instruction code,
address and output data are all parallelized on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3.
Note:
134/180
The dummy byte bits can not be parallelized: 8 clock cycles are requested to perform the
internal reading operation.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 72. Read OTP instruction and data-out sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
C
Instruction
Data
out 1
Data
out n
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Dummy (ex.: 10)
Quad_Read_OTP
9.3.4
Write Enable (WREN)
The Write Enable (WREN) instruction sets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit. Apart form the
parallelizing of the instruction code on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Enable instruction of the Extended
SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.9: Write Enable (WREN) for further details.
Figure 73. Write Enable instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Write_Enable
135/180
Instructions
9.3.5
N25Q128 - 3 V
Write Disable (WRDI)
The Write Disable (WRDI) instruction resets the Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and
DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Disable (WRDI)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.10: Write Disable
(WRDI) for further details.
Figure 74. Write Disable instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Write_Disable
9.3.6
Quad Command Page Program (QCPP)
The Quad Command Page Program (QCPP) instruction allows to program the memory
content in DIO-SPI protocol, parallelizing the instruction code, the address and the input
data on four pins (DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable
(WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. The Quad Command Page
Program (QCPP) instruction can be issued, when the device is set in QIO-SPI mode, by
sending to the memory indifferently one of the 3 instructions codes: 02h, 12h or 32h, the
effect is exactly the same. The 3 instruction codes are all accepted to help the application
code porting from Extended SPI protocol to QIO-SPI protocol.
Apart for the parallelizing on four pins of the instruction code, the Quad Command Page
Program instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Quad Input Extended Fast
Program of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.15: Quad Input Extended
Fast Program for further details.
136/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 75. Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 02h
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
514
515
516
517
518
519
Mode 0
24-bit address
1
2
Data In
3
Data In
254
255
4
256
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
3
7
3
7
3
MSB
MSB
MSB
7
MSB
MSB
MSB
Quad_Command_Page_Program_02h
Figure 76. Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 12h
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
514
515
516
517
518
519
Mode 0
24-bit address
1
2
Data In
3
Data In
254
255
4
256
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
3
7
3
7
3
MSB
MSB
MSB
7
MSB
MSB
MSB
Quad_Command_Page_Program_12h
137/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 77. Quad Command Page Program instruction sequence QIO-SPI, 32h
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
514
515
516
517
518
519
Mode 0
24-bit address
1
2
Data In
3
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
6
2
6
DQ3
23 19 15 11 7
3
7
3
7
3
7
MSB
Data In
254
255
4
256
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
MSB
Quad_Command_Page_Program_12h
9.3.7
Program OTP instruction (POTP)
The Program OTP instruction (POTP) is used to program at most 64 bytes to the OTP
memory area (by changing bits from 1 to 0, only). Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable
(WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, address and input data on the four pins
DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality (as well as the locking OTP method)
is exactly the same as the Program OTP (POTP) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol,
please refer to Section 9.1.16: Program OTP instruction (POTP) for further details.
138/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 78. Program OTP instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Data
byte1
Data Data
byte 2 byte n
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
Quad_Program_OTP
9.3.8
Subsector Erase (SSE)
For devices with a dedicated part number, at the bottom (or top) of the addressable area
there are 8 boot sectors, each one having 16 4Kbytes subsectors. (See Section 16:
Ordering information.) The Subsector Erase (SSE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside
the chosen subsector. Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must
previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the address on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Subsector Erase
(SSE) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.17: Subsector
Erase (SSE) for further details.
139/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 79. Subsector Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
3
7
Quad_Subsector_Erase
9.3.9
Sector Erase (SE)
The Sector Erase (SE) instruction sets to '1' (FFh) all bits inside the chosen sector. Before it
can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the address on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Sector Erase
(SE) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.18: Sector Erase
(SE) for further details.
Figure 80. Sector Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
3
7
Quad_Sector_Erase
140/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
9.3.10
Instructions
Bulk Erase (BE)
The Bulk Erase (BE) instruction sets all bits to '1' (FFh). Before it can be accepted, a Write
Enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and
DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Bulk Erase (BE) instruction of
the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.19: Bulk Erase (BE) for further
details.
Figure 81. Bulk Erase instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Bulk_Erase
9.3.11
Program/Erase Suspend
The Program/Erase Suspend instruction allows the controller to interrupt a Program or an
Erase instruction, in particular: Sector Erase and Quad Command Page Program can be
suspended and erased while that Subsector Erase, Bulk Erase, Write Non Volatile
Configuration register and Program OTP can not be suspended.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and
DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Program/Erase Suspend (PES)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.20: Program/Erase
Suspend for further details.
141/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 82. Program/Erase Suspend instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Program_Erase_Suspend
9.3.12
Program/Erase Resume
After a Program/Erase suspend instruction, a Program/Erase Resume instruction is
required to continue performing the suspended Program or Erase sequence.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code on the four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and
DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Program/Erase Resume (PER)
instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.21: Program/Erase
Resume for further details.
142/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 83. Program/Erase Resume instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Program_Erase_Resume
9.3.13
Read Status Register (RDSR)
The Read Status Register (RDSR) instruction allows the Status Register to be read.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the output data on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read Status
Register (RDSR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to Section 9.1.22:
Read Status Register (RDSR) for further details.
143/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 84. Read Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
C
Status Register Out
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Quad_Read_SR
9.3.14
Write status register (WRSR)
The write status register (WRSR) instruction allows new values to be written to the status
register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have
been executed.
The instruction code and the input data are sent on four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3. The
instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Status Register (WRSR) instruction
of the Extended SPI protocol (See Section 9.1.23: Write status register (WRSR)). However,
the protection feature management is different. In particular, once SRWD bit is set to '1' the
device enters in the hardware protected mode (HPM) independently from Write Protect
(W/VPP) signal value. To exit the HPM mode is needed to switch temporarily to the
Extended SPI protocol.
144/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 85. Write Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
C
Status Register In
DQ0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
Quad_Write_SR
9.3.15
Read Lock Register (RDLR)
The Read Lock Register instructions is used to read the lock register content.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, the address and the output data on the
four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the
Read Lock Register (RDLR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.24: Read Lock Register (RDLR) for further details.
145/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 86. Read Lock Register instruction and data-out sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Instruction
24-bit address
Lock Register Out
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Quad_Read_LR
9.3.16
Write to Lock Register (WRLR)
The Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction allows bits to be changed in the Lock
Registers. Before it can be accepted, a Write Enable (WREN) instruction must previously
have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code, the address and the input data on the
four pins DQ0, DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the
Write to Lock Register (WRLR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.25: Write to Lock Register (WRLR) for further details.
146/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 87. Write to Lock Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
C
Instruction
24-Bit Address
Lock Register In
DQ0
20 16 12 8
4
0
4
0
DQ1
21 17 13 9
5
1
5
1
DQ2
22 18 14 10 6
2
6
2
DQ3
23 19 15 11
3
7
3
7
Quad_Write_LR
9.3.17
Read Flag Status Register
The Read Flag Status Register (RFSR) instruction allows the Flag Status Register to be
read.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the output data on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Read Flag
Status Register (RFSR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.26: Read Flag Status Register for further details.
147/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 88. Read Flag Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Mode 0
Flag Status Register Out
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Quad_Read_Flag_SR
9.3.18
Clear Flag Status Register
The Clear Flag Status Register (CLFSR) instruction reset the error Flag Status Register bits
(Erase Error bit, Program Error bit, VPP Error bit, Protection Error bit). It is not necessary to
set the WEL bit before the Clear Flag Status Register instruction is executed. The WEL bit
will be unchanged after this command is executed.
148/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 89. Clear Flag Status Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
C
Instruction
DQ0
DQ1
DQ2
DQ3
Quad_Clear_Flag_SR
9.3.19
Read NV Configuration Register
The Read Non Volatile Configuration Register (RDNVCR) instruction allows the Non Volatile
Configuration Register to be read.
149/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 90. Read NV Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
C
Instruction
Nonvolatile Configuration
Register Out
DQ0
4
0 12 8
DQ1
5
1 13 9
DQ2
6
2 14 10
DQ3
7
3 15 11
LS Byte MS Byte
Quad_Read_NVCR
9.3.20
Write NV Configuration Register
The Write Non Volatile Configuration register (WRNVCR) instruction allows new values to
be written to the Non Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write
enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed.
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Non
Volatile Configuration Register (WRNVCR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please
refer to Section 9.1.29: Write NV Configuration Register for further details.
150/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 91. Write NV Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
C
Instruction
Nonvolatile Configuration
Register In
DQ0
4
0 12 8
DQ1
5
1 13 9
DQ2
6
2 14 10
DQ3
7
3 15 11
LS Byte MS Byte
Quad_Write_NVCR
9.3.21
Read Volatile Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Configuration Register (RDVCR) instruction allows the Volatile
Configuration Register to be read.
151/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 92. Read Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Volatile Configuration Register Out
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Quad_Read_VCR
9.3.22
Write Volatile Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Configuration register (WRVCR) instruction allows new values to be
written to the Volatile Configuration register. Before it can be accepted, a write enable
(WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. In case of Fast POR, the WREN
instruction is not required because a WREN instruction gets the device out from the Fast
POR state (See Section 11.1: Fast POR).
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Volatile
Configuration Register (WRVCR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol, please refer to
Section 9.1.31: Write Volatile Configuration Register for further details.
152/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 93. Write Volatile Configuration Register instruction sequence QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
C
Volatile Configuration
Register In
DQ0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
Quad_Write_VCR
9.3.23
Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register (RDVECR) instruction allows the
Volatile Configuration Register to be read.
153/180
Instructions
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 94. Read Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
C
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register Out
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
Quad_Read_VECR
9.3.24
Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register
The Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration register (WRVECR) instruction allows new
values to be written to the Volatile Enhanced Configuration register. Before it can be
accepted, a write enable (WREN) instruction must previously have been executed. In case
of Fast POR the WREN instruction is not required because a WREN instruction gets the
device out from the Fast POR state (See Section 11.1: Fast POR).
Apart form the parallelizing of the instruction code and the input data on the four pins DQ0,
DQ1, DQ2 and DQ3, the instruction functionality is exactly the same as the Write Volatile
Enhanced Configuration Register (WRVECR) instruction of the Extended SPI protocol,
please refer to Section 9.1.33: Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register for further
details.
154/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Instructions
Figure 95. Write Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register instruction sequence
QIO-SPI
S
0
1
2
3
C
Instruction
Volatile Enhanced
Configuration Register In
DQ0
4
0
DQ1
5
1
DQ2
6
2
DQ3
7
3
Quad_Write_VECR
155/180
XIP Operations
10
N25Q128 - 3 V
XIP Operations
XIP (eXecution in Place) mode is available in each protocol: Extended SPI, DIO-SPI, and
QIO-SPI. XIP mode allows the memory to be read simply by sending an address to the
device and then receiving the data on one, two, or four pins in parallel, depending on the
customer requirements. It offers maximum flexibility to the application, saves instruction
overhead, and allows a dramatic reduction to the Random Access time.
You can enable XIP mode in two ways:
„
Using the Volatile Configuration Register: this is dedicated to applications that boot in
SPI mode (Extended SPI, DIO-SPI or QIO-SPI) and then during the application life
need to switch to XIP mode to directly execute some code in the flash.
„
Using the Non Volatile Configuration Register: this is dedicated to applications that
need to boot directly in XIP mode.
Setting to 0 the bit 3 of the Volatile Configuration Register the device is ready to enter in XIP
mode right after the next fast read instruction (by 1, 2 or 4 pin).
While acting on the Non Volatile Configuration Register (bit 11 to bit 9, depending on which
XIP type is required, single, dual or quad I/O) the memory enters in the selected XIP mode
only after the next power-on sequence. The Non Volatile Configuration Register XIP
configuration bits allows the memory to start directly in the required XIP mode (Single, Dual
or Quad) after the power on.
The XIP mode status must be confirmed forcing the XIP confirmation bit to "0", the XIP
confirmation bit is the value on the DQ0 pin during the first dummy clock cycle after the
address in XIP reading instruction. Forcing the bit "1" on DQ0 during the first dummy clock
cycle after the address (XIP Confirmation bit) the memory returns in the previous standard
read mode, that means it will codify as an instruction code the next byte received on the
input pin(s) after the next chip select. Instead, if the XIP mode is confirmed (by forcing the
XIP confirmation bit to 0), after the device next de-selection and selection cycle, the memory
codify the first 3 bytes received on the inputs pin(s) as a new address.
Besides not confirming the XIP mode during the first dummy clock cycle, it is possible to exit
the XIP mode by mean of a dedicated rescue sequence.
Note:
156/180
For devices with a feature set digit equal to 2 or 4 in the part number (Basic XiP), it is not
necessary to set the Volatile Configuration Register bit 3 to enter XIP mode: it is possible to
enter XIP mode directly by setting XIP Confirmation bit to 1 during the first dummy clock
cycle after a fast read instruction.See Section 16: Ordering information.
N25Q128 - 3 V
XIP Operations
Figure 96. N25Q128 Read functionality Flow Chart
Power On
NVCR Check
No
Is XIP enabled ?
Yes
SPI standard mode (no
XiP, VCR <3> = 1)
VCR<3> = 0 ?
Yes
SPI mode (no XIP) but
ready to enter XIP
No
No
XIP mode
Read Instructions ?
Yes
Yes
No
XiP Confirmation
bit = 0 ?
No
XiP Confirmation
bit = 0 ?
Yes
10.1
Enter XIP mode by setting the Non Volatile Configuration
Register
To use the Non Volatile Configuration Register method to enter in XIP mode it is necessary
to set the Non Volatile Configuration Register bits from 11 to 9 with the pattern
corresponding to the required XIP mode by mean of the Write Non Volatile Configuration
Register (WRNVCR) instruction. (See Table 24.: NVCR XIP bits setting example.)
This instruction doesn't affect the XIP state until the next Power on sequence. In this case,
after the next power on sequence, the memory directly accept addresses and then, after the
dummy clock cycles (configurable), outputs the data as described in Table 24.: NVCR XIP
bits setting example. For example to enable fast POR and XIP on QIOFR in normal SPI
protocol with six dummy clock cycles the following pattern must be issued:
157/180
XIP Operations
Table 24.
N25Q128 - 3 V
NVCR XIP bits setting example
B1h
(WRNVCR
opcode)
+ 0110
100
111
0
1
11
xx
6 dummy cycles
for fast read
instructions
XIP set as
default; Quad
I/O mode
Output Buffer
driver strength
default
FAST POR
enabled
Hold/Reset
not disabled
Extended
SPI protocol
Don’t
Care
Figure 97. XIP mode directly after power on
NVCR check: XIP enabled
Vd
tVSI (<100μ)
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0 Xb
4
0
4
0
4
DQ1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
DQ2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
DQ3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 6)
Byte 1 Byte 2
Quad_XIP_After_Power-On
Note:
158/180
Xb is the XIP Confirmation bit, and it should be set to '0' to keep XIP state or '1' to exit XIP
mode and return to standard read mode.
N25Q128 - 3 V
10.2
XIP Operations
Enter XIP mode by setting the Volatile Configuration Register
To use the Volatile Configuration Register method to enter XIP mode, it is necessary to write
a 0 to bit 3 of the Volatile Configuration Register to make the device ready to enter XIP
mode (2). This instruction doesn't permit to enter XIP state directly: a Fast Read instruction
(either Single, Dual or Quad) is needed once to start the XIP Reading.
After the Fast Read instruction (Single, Dual or Quad) the XIP confirmation bit must be set
to 0. (first bit on DQ0 during the first dummy cycle after the address has been received),
Then after the next de-select and select cycle (S pin set to 1 and then to 0) the memory
codify the first 3 bytes received on the input pin(s) directly as an address, without any
instruction code, and after the dummy clock cycles (configurable) directly outputs the data.
For example to enable the XIP (without enter) with six dummy clock cycles, the pattern in
Table 25.: VCR XIP bits setting example must be issued, and after that it is possible to enter,
for example, in XIP mode from extended SPI read mode by mean of Quad Input Output Fast
Read instruction, as described in Table 25.: VCR XIP bits setting example.
Note:
For devices with a feature set digit equal to 2 or 4 in the part number (Basic XiP), it is not
necessary to set the Volatile Configuration Register bit 3 to enter in XIP mode: it is possible
to enter directly in XIP mode by setting XIP Confirmation bit to 1 during the first dummy
clock cycle after a fast read instruction. See Section 16: Ordering information.
Table 25.
VCR XIP bits setting example
81h (WRVCR opcode)
+ 0110
0
000
6 dummy
cycles
Ready for
XIP
Reserved
159/180
XIP Operations
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 98. XiP: enter by VCR 2/2 (QIOFR in normal SPI protocol example)
S
Mode 3
C
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23
Mode 0
IO switches from Input to Output
Instruction
DQ0
4
0
4
0
4
0 Xb
4
0
4
0
4
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
1
5
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
2
6
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
3
7
Don’t Care
DQ1
Don’t Care
DQ2
DQ3
‘1’
A23-16 A15-8 A7-0
Dummy (ex.: 6)
Byte 1 Byte 2
XIP_VCR
Note:
Xb is the XIP Confirmation bit, and it should be set to '0' to keep XIP state or '1' to exit XIP
mode and return to standard read mode.
10.3
XIP mode hold and exit
The XIP mode does require at least one additional clock cycle to allow the XIP Confirmation
bit to be sent to the memory on DQ0 during the first dummy clock cycle.
The device decodes the XIP Confirmation bit with the scheme:
„
XIP Confirmation bit=0 means to hold XIP Mode
„
XIP Confirmation bit=1 means to exit XIP Mode and comes back to read mode, that
means codifying the first byte after the next chip select as an instruction code.
In Dual I/O XIP mode, the values of DQ1 during the first dummy clock cycle after the
addresses is always Don't Care.
In Quad I/O XIP mode, the values of DQ3, DQ2 and DQ1 during the first dummy clock cycle
after the addresses are always Don't Care.
In Dual and Single I/O XIP mode, in presence of the RESET pin enabled (in devices with a
dedicated part number), a low pulse on that pin resets the XIP protocol as defined by the
Volatile Configuration Register, reporting the memory at the state of last power up, as
defined by the Non Volatile Configuration Register. In Quad I/O XiP modes, it is possible to
reset the memory (for devices with a dedicated part number) only when the device is
deselected. See Section 16: Ordering information.
160/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
10.4
XIP Operations
XIP Memory reset after a controller reset
If during the application life the system controller is reset during operation, and the device
features the RESET functionality (in devices with a dedicated part number), and the feature
has not been disabled, after the controller resets, the memory returns to POR state and
there is no issue. See Section 16: Ordering information.
In all the other cases, it is possible to exit the memory from the XIP mode by sending the
following rescue sequence at the first chip selection after a system reset:
DQ0= '1' for:
7 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 8th clock cycle)
+ 13 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 14th clock cycle)
+ 25 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 26th clock cycle)
The global effect is only to exit from XIP without any other reset.
161/180
Power-up and power-down
11
N25Q128 - 3 V
Power-up and power-down
At power-up and power-down, the device must not be selected (that is Chip Select (S) must
follow the voltage applied on VCC) until VCC reaches the correct value:
„
VCC(min) at power-up, and then for a further delay of tVSL
„
VSS at power-down
A safe configuration is provided in Section 3: SPI Modes.
To avoid data corruption and inadvertent write operations during power-up, a Power On
Reset (POR) circuit is included. The logic inside the device is held reset while VCC is less
than the Power On Reset (POR) threshold voltage, VWI - all operations are disabled, and
the device does not respond to any instruction.
Moreover, the device ignores the Write Enable (WREN) instruction and all the modify
instructions until a time delay of tPUW has elapsed after the moment that VCC rises above
the VWI threshold. However, the correct operation of the device is not guaranteed if, by this
time, VCC is still below VCC(min). No Write Status Register, Program or Erase instructions
should be sent until the later of:
„
tPUW after VCC has passed the VWI threshold
„
tVSL after VCC has passed the VCC(min) level
These values are specified in Table 26.: Power-up timing and VWI threshold.
If the time, tVSL, has elapsed, after VCC rises above VCC(min), the device can be selected
for READ instructions even if the tPUW delay has not yet fully elapsed.
After power-up, the device is in the following state:
„
The device is in the Standby Power mode (not the Deep Power-down mode)
„
The Write Enable Latch (WEL) bit is reset
„
The Write In Progress (WIP) bit is reset
„
The Lock Registers are configured as: (Write Lock bit, Lock Down bit) = (0,0).
Normal precautions must be taken for supply line decoupling, to stabilize the VCC supply.
Each device in a system should have the VCC line decoupled by a suitable capacitor close
to the package pins (generally, this capacitor is of the order of 100 nF).
At power-down, when VCC drops from the operating voltage, to below the Power On Reset
(POR) threshold voltage, VWI, all operations are disabled and the device does not respond
to any instruction (the designer needs to be aware that if power-down occurs while a Write,
Program or Erase cycle is in progress, some data corruption may result).
VPPH must be applied only when VCC is stable and in the VCC(min) to VCC(max) voltage
range.
162/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
Power-up and power-down
Figure 99. Power-up timing, Fast POR selected
Vcc
VCC(max)
WREN issued
Chip selection not allowed
VCC(min)
tVTR
Chip
tDTW
Polling allowed
reset
Polling
WRECR allowed
allowed
Starting protocol defined by NVCR
SPI protocol
VWI
Device fully accessible
All read, WRCR,
WIP = 1
WIP = 0
WIP = 1
WIP = 0
WEL = 0
WEL = 0
WEL = 1
WEL = 1
time
Figure 100. Power-up timing, Fast POR not selected
Vcc
VCC(max)
Chip selection not allowed
VCC(min)
tVTW = tVTR + tDTW
Chip
Polling allowed
Device fully accessible
reset
SPI protocol
VWI
Starting protocol defined by NVCR
WIP = 1
WIP = 0
WEL = 0
WEL = 0
time
Table 26.
Power-up timing and VWI threshold
Symbol
tVTR(1)
Min
Max
Unit
VCC(min) to Read when Fast POR is selected
100
µs
(1)
Time delay to write instruction when Fast POR is selected
500
µs
(1)
VCC(min) to device fully accessible
600
µs
2.5
V
tDTW
tVTW
Parameter
VWI(1)
Write inhibit voltage
1.5
1. These parameters are characterized only.
163/180
Power-up and power-down
11.1
N25Q128 - 3 V
Fast POR
The Fast POR feature is available to speed up the power-on sequence for applications that
only require reading the memory after the power on sequence (no modify instructions).
If enabled, the Fast POR allows read operations and Volatile Configuration Register and
Volatile Enhanced Configuration Register modifications after less than 100us, providing a
substantially faster application boot phase.
In any case, even if the Fast POR sequence is selected, it is still possible to execute a
modify instruction (erase or program) issuing a WREN instruction. In this case the device
will have a latency time (~500us) after the first WREN instruction to complete POR
sequence. During this latency time, when the power on second phase is running, no
instruction will be accepted except for the polling instruction. During the power on second
phase, both WEL & WIP bits are set to 1. At the end of POR sequence only the WEL bit is
still set to 1.
To select or deselect the Fast POR feature, a Write non Volatile Configuration Register
(WRNVCR) instruction is needed to properly set the dedicated bit (bit 5) of the Non Volatile
Configuration Register.
11.2
Rescue sequence in case of power loss during WRNVCR
If a power loss occurs during a Write Non Volatile Configuration Register instruction, after
the next power on the device could eventually wake up in a not determined state, for
example a not required protocol or XIP mode. In that case a particular rescue sequence
must be used to recover the device at a fixed state (Extended SPI protocol without XIP) until
the next power up. Then to fix the problem definitively is recommended to run the Write Non
Volatile configuration Register again.
The rescue sequence is composed of two parts that have to be run in the correct order.
During all the sequence the TSHSL must be 50ns at least. The sequence is:
DQ0 (PAD DATA) equal to '1' for:
7 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 8th clock cycle)
+ 13 clock cycles within S low S becomes high before 14th clock cycle)
+ 25 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 26th clock cycle)
To exit from XIP.
DQ0 (PAD DATA) and DQ3 (PAD HOLD) equal to '1' for:
8 clock cycles within S low (S becomes high before 9th clock cycle) to force Normal SPI
protocol.
164/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
12
Initial delivery state
Initial delivery state
The device is delivered with the memory array erased: all bits are set to 1 (each byte
contains FFh). The Status Register contains 00h (all Status Register bits are 0).
13
Maximum rating
Stressing the device outside the ratings listed here may cause permanent damage to the
device. These are stress ratings only, and operation of the device at these, or any other
conditions outside those indicated in the operating sections of this specification, is not
implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect
device reliability.
Table 27.
Absolute maximum ratings
Symbol
Parameter
TSTG
TLEAD
Storage temperature
Min
Max
Unit
–65
150
°C
see(1)
°C
Lead temperature during soldering
VIO
Input and output voltage (with respect to ground)
–0.6
VCC + 0.6
V
VCC
Supply voltage
–0.6
4.0
V
–0.2
10.0
V
–2000
2000
V
VPP
VESD
Fast program/erase
voltage(2)
Electrostatic discharge voltage (human body
model)(3)
1. Compliant with JEDEC Std. J-STD-020C (for small body, Sn-Pb or Pb assembly), the Numonyx
ECOPACK® 7191395 specification, and the European directive on Restrictions on Hazardous
Substances (RoHS) 2002/95/EU.
2. Avoid applying VPPH to the W/VPP pin during Bulk Erase.
3. JEDEC Std JESD22-A114A (C1 = 100 pF, R1 = 1500 Ω, R2 = 500 Ω).
165/180
DC and AC parameters
14
N25Q128 - 3 V
DC and AC parameters
This section summarizes the operating and measurement conditions, and the DC and AC
characteristics of the device. The parameters in the DC and AC characteristics tables that
follow are derived from tests performed under the measurement conditions summarized in
the relevant tables. Designers should check that the operating conditions in their circuit
match the measurement conditions when relying on the quoted parameters.
Table 28.
Operating conditions
Symbol
VCC
VPPH
TA
Table 29.
Parameter
Min
Typ
Unit
Supply voltage
2.7
3.6
V
Supply voltage on VPP
8.5
9.5
V
Ambient operating temperature
–40
85
°C
AC measurement conditions
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Unit
30(1)
Load capacitance
Input rise and fall times
CL
Max
pF
5
ns
Input pulse voltages
0.2VCC to 0.8VCC
V
Input timing reference voltages
0.3VCC to 0.7VCC
V
VCC / 2
V
Output timing reference voltages
1) Output Buffers are configurable by user.
Figure 101. AC measurement I/O waveform
Input levels
Input and output
timing reference levels
0.8VCC
0.7VCC
0.5VCC
0.3VCC
0.2VCC
AI07455
Table 30.
Symbol
CIN/OUT
CIN
Capacitance(1)
Parameter
Input/output capacitance
(DQ0/DQ1/DQ2/DQ3)
Input capacitance (other pins)
Test condition
Max
Unit
VOUT = 0 V
8
pF
VIN = 0 V
6
pF
1. Sampled only, not 100% tested, at TA=25 °C and a frequency of 54 MHz.
166/180
Min
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 31.
Symbol
DC and AC parameters
DC Characteristics
Parameter
Test condition (in addiction
to those in Table 28.:
Operating conditions)
Min
Max
Unit
ILI
Input leakage current
±2
µA
ILO
Output leakage current
±2
µA
ICC1
Standby current
S = VCC, VIN = VSS or VCC
100
µA
C = 0.1VCC / 0.9VCC at 108
MHz, DQ1 = open
15
mA
C = 0.1VCC / 0.9VCC at 54
MHz, DQ1 = open
6
mA
Operating current (Fast Read Dual I/O)
C = 0.1VCC / 0.9VCC at
108 MHz
18
mA
Operating current (Fast Read Quad I/O)
C = 0.1VCC / 0.9VCC at
108 MHz
20
mA
ICC4
Operating current (Page Program Single,
Dual and Quad I/O)
S = VCC
20
mA
ICC5
Operating current (WRSR)
S= VCC
20
mA
ICC6
Operating current (SE)
S = VCC
20
mA
VIL
Input low voltage
– 0.5
0.3VCC
V
VIH
Input high voltage
0.7VCC
VCC+0.4
V
VOL
Output low voltage
IOL = 1.6 mA
0.4
V
VOH
Output high voltage
IOH = –100 uA
Operating current (Fast Read Single I/O)
ICC3
VCC–0.2
V
167/180
DC and AC parameters
N25Q128 - 3 V
Note:
The AC Characteristics data is preliminary.
Table 32.
AC Characteristics (page 1 of 2)
Symbol
fC
Alt.
fC
fR
Parameter
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Clock frequency for the all the
instructions (Extended SPI, DIO-SPI and
D.C.
QIO-SPI protocol) but the READ instruction
108
Clock frequency for read instructions
D.C.
54
Unit
MHz
MHz
(1)
tCLH
Clock High time
4
ns
(2)
tCLL
Clock Low time
4
ns
tCLCH(3)
Clock rise time(4) (peak to peak)
0.1
V/ns
tCHCL(3)
Clock fall time(4) (peak to peak)
0.1
V/ns
S active setup time (relative to C)
4
ns
4
ns
tCH
tCL
tSLCH
tCSS
tCHSL
tDVCH
tDSU
Data in setup time
2
ns
tCHDX
tDH
Data in hold time
3
ns
tCHSH
S active hold time (relative to C)
4
ns
tSHCH
S not active setup time (relative to C)
4
ns
S deselect time after a correct read
instruction
20
ns
S deselect time after a not correct read or
after any different instruction
50
ns
tSHSL
tCSH
tSHQZ(3)
tDIS
tCLQV
tV
tCLQX
tHO
Output disable time
8
ns
Clock Low to Output valid under 30 pF
7
ns
Clock Low to Output valid under 10 pF
5
ns
Output hold time
1
ns
tHLCH
HOLD setup time (relative to C)
4
ns
tCHHH
HOLD hold time (relative to C)
4
ns
tHHCH
HOLD setup time (relative to C)
4
ns
tCHHL
HOLD hold time (relative to C)
4
ns
tHHQX(3)
tLZ
HOLD to Output Low-Z
8
ns
(3)
tHZ
HOLD to Output High-Z
8
ns
tHLQZ
tWHSL
(5)
tSHWL(5)
168/180
Write protect setup time
20
ns
Write protect hold time
100
ns
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 32.
Symbol
DC and AC parameters
AC Characteristics (page 2 of 2)
Alt.
Parameter
Typ(2)
Min
Max
Unit
tVPPHSL(6)
Enhanced program supply voltage High
(VPPH) to Chip Select Low for Single and
Dual I/O Page Program
tW
Write status register cycle time
1.3
tCFSR
Clear flag status register cycle time
40
tWNVCR
Write non volatile configuration register
cycle time
0.2
tWVCR
Write volatile configuration register cycle
time
40
ns
tWRVECR
Write volatile enhanced
configurationregister cycle time
40
ns
tPP(7)
Page program cycle time (n bytes)
int(n/8) ×
0.015(8)
Program OTP cycle time (64 bytes)
0.2
tSSE
Subsector erase cycle time
0.2
2
s
tSE
Sector erase cycle time
0.7
3
s
tBE
Bulk erase cycle time
170
250
s
ns
200
8
ms
ns
s
3
ms
5
ms
1. tCH + tCL must be greater than or equal to 1/ fC.
2. Typical values given for TA = 25 °C
3. Value guaranteed by characterization, not 100% tested in production.
4. Expressed as a slew-rate.
5. Only applicable as a constraint for a WRSR instruction when SRWD is set to '1'.
6. VPPH should be kept at a valid level until the program or erase operation has completed and its result (success or failure)
is known. Avoid applying VPPH to the W/VPP pin during Bulk Erase.
7. When using the page program (PP) instruction to program consecutive bytes, optimized timings are obtained with one
sequence including all the bytes versus several sequences of only a few bytes (1 < n < 256).
8. int(A) corresponds to the upper integer part of A. For example int(12/8) = 2, int(32/8) = 4 int(15.3) =16.
Figure 102. Reset AC waveforms while a program or erase cycle is in progress
S
tSHRH
Reset
tRHSL
tRLRH
AI06808
See Table 33.: Reset Conditions.
169/180
DC and AC parameters
Table 33.
Symbol
tRLRH(1)(2)
N25Q128 - 3 V
Reset Conditions
Alt.
tRST
Parameter
Conditions
Min
Reset pulse width
tRHSL(1)
tREC
ns
40
ns
Under completion of an internal erase or
program cycle related to POTP, PP, DIEFP, 30
DIFP, QIEFP, QIFP, SE, BE, PER, PES.
µs
Under completion of an SSE operation.
tSSE
ms
Under completion of an WRSR operation.
tW
ms
Under completion of an WRNVCR
operation.
tWNVCR
ms
Under completion of the first WREN issued
when Fast POR selected.
tDTW
µs
Device deselected (S high) and in XiP
mode.
S# deselect to R
valid
tSHRV(1)
Max Unit
50
Device selected (S low), while decoding
any modify instruction, during all read
operations, CLFSR, WRDI, WREN,
WRLR, WRVCR, WRVECR.
Reset Recovery
Time
Typ
40
ns
Device deselected (S high) and in Standby
40
mode.
ns
Deselect to R valid in Quad Output or in
QIO-SPI.
ns
2
1. All values are guaranteed by characterization and not 100% tested in production.
2. The device reset is possible but not guaranteed if tRLRH < 50 ns.
Figure 103. Serial input timing
tSHSL
S
tCHSL
tSLCH
tCHSH
tSHCH
C
tDVCH
tCHCL
tCHDX
DQ0
DQ1
MSB IN
tCLCH
LSB IN
High Impedance
AI13728
170/180
N25Q128 - 3 V
DC and AC parameters
Figure 104. Write protect setup and hold timing during WRSR when SRWD=1
W/VPP
tSHWL
tWHSL
S
C
DQ0
High Impedance
DQ1
AI07439c
Figure 105. Hold timing
S
tHLCH
tCHHL
tHHCH
C
tCHHH
tHLQZ
tHHQX
DQ1
DQ0
HOLD
AI13746
171/180
DC and AC parameters
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 106. Output timing
S
tCH
C
tCLQV
tCLQX
tCLQV
tCL
tCLQX
LSB OUT
DQ1
DQ0
tSHQZ
ADDR.
LSB IN
AI13729
Figure 107. VPPH timing
End of command
(identified by WIP polling)
S
C
DQ0
VPPH
VPP
tVPPHSL
172/180
ai13726-b
N25Q128 - 3 V
15
Package mechanical
Package mechanical
In order to meet environmental requirements, Numonyx offers these devices in RoHS
compliant packages. These packages have a lead-free second level interconnect. The
category of second level interconnect is marked on the package and on the inner box label,
in compliance with JEDEC Standard JESD97. The maximum ratings related to soldering
conditions are also marked on the inner box label.
Figure 108. VDFPN8 (MLP8) 8-lead very thin dual flat package no lead,
8 × 6 mm, package outline
D
E
E2
e
b
D2
A
L
L1
K
ddd
A1
VDFPN-02
1. Drawing is not to scale.
2. The circle in the top view of the package indicates the position of pin 1.
Table 34.
VDFPN8 (MLP8) 8-lead very thin dual flat package no lead,
8 × 6 mm, package mechanical data
Millimeters
Inches
Symbol
Typ
A
Min
0.85
A1
b
0.40
D
8.00
D2
5.16
1.00
0.033
0.05
0.35
0.48
0.016
Min
Max
0.000
0.002
0.014
0.019
0.039
0.315
(1)
0.203
0.05
E
6.00
E2
4.80
e
1.27
K
0.002
0.236
0.189
–
–
0.050
0.82
0.50
0.45
L1
N
Typ
0.00
ddd
L
Max
–
0.032
0.60
0.020
0.018
0.15
8
–
0.024
0.006
8
1. D2 Max must not exceed (D – K – 2 × L).
173/180
Package mechanical
N25Q128 - 3 V
Figure 109. SO16 wide - 16-lead plastic small outline, 300 mils body width, package
outline
D
16
h x 45˚
9
C
E
1
θ
8
A2
B
H
A1
A
L
ddd
e
SO-H
1. Drawing is not to scale.
Table 35.
SO16 wide - 16-lead plastic small outline, 300 mils body width,
mechanical data
Millimeters
Inches
Symbol
Typ
Min
Max
A
2.35
A1
Min
Max
2.65
0.093
0.104
0.10
0.30
0.004
0.012
B
0.33
0.51
0.013
0.020
C
0.23
0.32
0.009
0.013
D
10.10
10.50
0.398
0.413
E
7.40
7.60
0.291
0.299
–
–
–
–
H
10.00
10.65
0.394
0.419
h
0.25
0.75
0.010
0.030
L
0.40
1.27
0.016
0.050
θ
0°
8°
0°
8°
e
ddd
174/180
1.27
0.10
Typ
0.050
0.004
N25Q128 - 3 V
Package mechanical
Figure 110. TBGA - 6 x 8 mm, 24-ball, mechanical package outline
1. Drawing is not to scale.
175/180
Package mechanical
N25Q128 - 3 V
Table 36.
TBGA 6x8 mm 24-ball package dimensions
MIN
NOM
A
A1
1.20
0.20
A2
0.79
Øb
0.35
0.40
0.45
D
5.90
6.00
6.10
D1
E
4.00
7.90
8.00
E1
4.00
eD
1.00
eE
1.00
FD
1.00
FE
2.00
MD
5
ME
5
n
24 balls
8.10
aaa
0.15
bbb
0.10
ddd
0.10
eee
0.15
fff
0.08
Control unit: mm
176/180
MAX
N25Q128 - 3 V
Ordering information
16
Ordering information
Note:
For further information on line items not listed here or on any aspect of this device, please
contact your nearest Numonyx Sales Office.
Table 37.
Ordering information scheme
Example:
N25Q128
A 1 3
B
F8 4
0
E
Device type
N25Q = serial Flash memory, Quad I/O, XiP
Device density
128 = 128 Mbit
Technology
A = 65 nm
Feature set
1 = Byte addressability, Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
2 = Byte addressability, Hold pin, Basic XiP
3 = Byte addressability, Reset pin, Numonyx XiP
4 = Byte addressability, Reset pin, Basic XiP
Operating voltage
3 = VCC = 2.7 V to 3.6 V
Block Structure
B = Bottom
T = Top
E = Uniform (no boot sectors)
Package
F8 = VDFPN8 8 x 6 mm (MLP8) (RoHS compliant)
SF = SO16 (300 mils width) (RoHS compliant)
12 = TBGA24 6 x 8 mm (RoHS compliant)
Temperature and test flow
4 = Industrial temperature range, –40 to 85 °C
Device tested with standard test flow
A = Automotive temperature range, –40 to 125 °C
Device tested with high reliability certified test flow
H = Industrial temperature range, –40 to 85 °C
Device tested with high reliability certified test flow
Security features (1)
0 = No extra security
Packing options
E = Tray packing
F = Tape and reel packing
G = Tube packing
1. Additional secure options are available upon customer request.
177/180
Ordering information
Table 38.
N25Q128 - 3 V
Valid Order Information Line Items
Part Number
Features
Block
Structure
Package
Temperature and
Test Flow
Security
N25Q128A13BF840E
N25Q128A13BF840F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Bottom
VDFPN8
8x6 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23BF840E
N25Q128A23BF840F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Bottom
VDFPN8
8x6 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A13TF840E
N25Q128A13TF840F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Top
VDFPN8
8x6 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23TF840E
N25Q128A23TF840F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Top
VDFPN8
8x6 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A13B1240E
N25Q128A13B1240F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Bottom
TBGA24
6x8 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23B1240E
N25Q128A23B1240F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Bottom
TBGA24
6x8 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A13T1240E
N25Q128A13T1240F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Top
TBGA24
6x8 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23T1240E
N25Q128A23T1240F
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Top
TBGA24
6x8 mm
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A13BSF40F
N25Q128A13BSF40G
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Bottom
SO16 (300
mils width)
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23BSF40F
N25Q128A23BSF40G
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Bottom
SO16 (300
mils width)
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A13TSF40F
N25Q128A13TSF40G
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Numonyx XiP
Top
SO16 (300
mils width)
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
N25Q128A23TSF40F
N25Q128A23TSF40G
Byte addressability,
Hold pin, Basic XiP
Top
SO16 (300
mils width)
Industrial temp;
Standard test flow
No extra
security
Note:
178/180
Packing information details: E= tray, F= tape-n-reel, G= tube (16th digit of part number).
N25Q128 - 3 V
17
Revision history
Revision history
Table 39.
Document revision history
Date
Revision
12-Feb.-2010
1.0
Changes
Initial public release.
179/180
M25Q128 - 3 V
Please Read Carefully:
INFORMATION IN THIS DOCUMENT IS PROVIDED IN CONNECTION WITH NUMONYX™ PRODUCTS. NO LICENSE, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, BY ESTOPPEL OR OTHERWISE, TO ANY INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS IS GRANTED BY THIS DOCUMENT. EXCEPT
AS PROVIDED IN NUMONYX'S TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE FOR SUCH PRODUCTS, NUMONYX ASSUMES NO LIABILITY
WHATSOEVER, AND NUMONYX DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY, RELATING TO SALE AND/OR USE OF
NUMONYX PRODUCTS INCLUDING LIABILITY OR WARRANTIES RELATING TO FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
MERCHANTABILITY, OR INFRINGEMENT OF ANY PATENT, COPYRIGHT OR OTHER INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHT.
Numonyx products are not intended for use in medical, life saving, life sustaining, critical control or safety systems, or in nuclear facility
applications.
Numonyx may make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time, without notice.
Numonyx, B.V. may have patents or pending patent applications, trademarks, copyrights, or other intellectual property rights that relate to the
presented subject matter. The furnishing of documents and other materials and information does not provide any license, express or implied,
by estoppel or otherwise, to any such patents, trademarks, copyrights, or other intellectual property rights.
Designers must not rely on the absence or characteristics of any features or instructions marked “reserved” or “undefined.” Numonyx reserves
these for future definition and shall have no responsibility whatsoever for conflicts or incompatibilities arising from future changes to them.
Contact your local Numonyx sales office or your distributor to obtain the latest specifications and before placing your product order.
Copies of documents which have an order number and are referenced in this document, or other Numonyx literature may be obtained by
visiting Numonyx's website at http://www.numonyx.com.
Numonyx StrataFlash is a trademark or registered trademark of Numonyx or its subsidiaries in the United States and other countries.
*Other names and brands may be claimed as the property of others.
Copyright © 2010, Numonyx B.V. All Rights Reserved.
180/180